Home | History | Annotate | Line # | Download | only in bfd
elf.c revision 1.3
      1  1.1     skrll /* ELF executable support for BFD.
      2  1.1     skrll 
      3  1.1     skrll    Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
      4  1.3  christos    2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
      5  1.3  christos    Free Software Foundation, Inc.
      6  1.1     skrll 
      7  1.1     skrll    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
      8  1.1     skrll 
      9  1.1     skrll    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
     10  1.1     skrll    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
     11  1.1     skrll    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
     12  1.1     skrll    (at your option) any later version.
     13  1.1     skrll 
     14  1.1     skrll    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
     15  1.1     skrll    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
     16  1.1     skrll    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
     17  1.1     skrll    GNU General Public License for more details.
     18  1.1     skrll 
     19  1.1     skrll    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
     20  1.1     skrll    along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
     21  1.1     skrll    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
     22  1.1     skrll    MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
     23  1.1     skrll 
     24  1.1     skrll 
     25  1.1     skrll /*
     26  1.1     skrll SECTION
     27  1.1     skrll 	ELF backends
     28  1.1     skrll 
     29  1.1     skrll 	BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
     30  1.1     skrll 	Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
     31  1.1     skrll 	(running svr4 or Solaris 2).
     32  1.1     skrll 
     33  1.1     skrll 	Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
     34  1.1     skrll 	to be written.  The code is changing quickly enough that we
     35  1.1     skrll 	haven't bothered yet.  */
     36  1.1     skrll 
     37  1.1     skrll /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32.  */
     38  1.1     skrll #define _SYSCALL32
     39  1.1     skrll #include "sysdep.h"
     40  1.1     skrll #include "bfd.h"
     41  1.1     skrll #include "bfdlink.h"
     42  1.1     skrll #include "libbfd.h"
     43  1.1     skrll #define ARCH_SIZE 0
     44  1.1     skrll #include "elf-bfd.h"
     45  1.1     skrll #include "libiberty.h"
     46  1.1     skrll #include "safe-ctype.h"
     47  1.1     skrll 
     48  1.3  christos #ifdef CORE_HEADER
     49  1.3  christos #include CORE_HEADER
     50  1.3  christos #endif
     51  1.3  christos 
     52  1.1     skrll static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
     53  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
     54  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
     55  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct bfd_strtab_hash **, int) ;
     56  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type) ;
     57  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
     58  1.1     skrll 				    file_ptr offset);
     59  1.1     skrll 
     60  1.1     skrll /* Swap version information in and out.  The version information is
     61  1.1     skrll    currently size independent.  If that ever changes, this code will
     62  1.1     skrll    need to move into elfcode.h.  */
     63  1.1     skrll 
     64  1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Verdef structure.  */
     65  1.1     skrll 
     66  1.1     skrll void
     67  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
     68  1.1     skrll 			 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
     69  1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
     70  1.1     skrll {
     71  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
     72  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_flags   = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
     73  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_ndx     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
     74  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_cnt     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
     75  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_hash    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
     76  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_aux     = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
     77  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_next    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
     78  1.1     skrll }
     79  1.1     skrll 
     80  1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Verdef structure.  */
     81  1.1     skrll 
     82  1.1     skrll void
     83  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
     84  1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
     85  1.1     skrll 			  Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
     86  1.1     skrll {
     87  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
     88  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
     89  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
     90  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
     91  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
     92  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
     93  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
     94  1.1     skrll }
     95  1.1     skrll 
     96  1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Verdaux structure.  */
     97  1.1     skrll 
     98  1.1     skrll void
     99  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
    100  1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
    101  1.1     skrll 			  Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
    102  1.1     skrll {
    103  1.1     skrll   dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
    104  1.1     skrll   dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
    105  1.1     skrll }
    106  1.1     skrll 
    107  1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Verdaux structure.  */
    108  1.1     skrll 
    109  1.1     skrll void
    110  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
    111  1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
    112  1.1     skrll 			   Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
    113  1.1     skrll {
    114  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
    115  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
    116  1.1     skrll }
    117  1.1     skrll 
    118  1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Verneed structure.  */
    119  1.1     skrll 
    120  1.1     skrll void
    121  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
    122  1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
    123  1.1     skrll 			  Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
    124  1.1     skrll {
    125  1.1     skrll   dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
    126  1.1     skrll   dst->vn_cnt     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
    127  1.1     skrll   dst->vn_file    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
    128  1.1     skrll   dst->vn_aux     = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
    129  1.1     skrll   dst->vn_next    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
    130  1.1     skrll }
    131  1.1     skrll 
    132  1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Verneed structure.  */
    133  1.1     skrll 
    134  1.1     skrll void
    135  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
    136  1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
    137  1.1     skrll 			   Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
    138  1.1     skrll {
    139  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
    140  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
    141  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
    142  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
    143  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
    144  1.1     skrll }
    145  1.1     skrll 
    146  1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Vernaux structure.  */
    147  1.1     skrll 
    148  1.1     skrll void
    149  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
    150  1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
    151  1.1     skrll 			  Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
    152  1.1     skrll {
    153  1.1     skrll   dst->vna_hash  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
    154  1.1     skrll   dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
    155  1.1     skrll   dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
    156  1.1     skrll   dst->vna_name  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
    157  1.1     skrll   dst->vna_next  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
    158  1.1     skrll }
    159  1.1     skrll 
    160  1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Vernaux structure.  */
    161  1.1     skrll 
    162  1.1     skrll void
    163  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
    164  1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
    165  1.1     skrll 			   Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
    166  1.1     skrll {
    167  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
    168  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
    169  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
    170  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
    171  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
    172  1.1     skrll }
    173  1.1     skrll 
    174  1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Versym structure.  */
    175  1.1     skrll 
    176  1.1     skrll void
    177  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
    178  1.1     skrll 			 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
    179  1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
    180  1.1     skrll {
    181  1.1     skrll   dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
    182  1.1     skrll }
    183  1.1     skrll 
    184  1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Versym structure.  */
    185  1.1     skrll 
    186  1.1     skrll void
    187  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
    188  1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
    189  1.1     skrll 			  Elf_External_Versym *dst)
    190  1.1     skrll {
    191  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
    192  1.1     skrll }
    193  1.1     skrll 
    194  1.1     skrll /* Standard ELF hash function.  Do not change this function; you will
    195  1.1     skrll    cause invalid hash tables to be generated.  */
    196  1.1     skrll 
    197  1.1     skrll unsigned long
    198  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
    199  1.1     skrll {
    200  1.1     skrll   const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
    201  1.1     skrll   unsigned long h = 0;
    202  1.1     skrll   unsigned long g;
    203  1.1     skrll   int ch;
    204  1.1     skrll 
    205  1.1     skrll   while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
    206  1.1     skrll     {
    207  1.1     skrll       h = (h << 4) + ch;
    208  1.1     skrll       if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
    209  1.1     skrll 	{
    210  1.1     skrll 	  h ^= g >> 24;
    211  1.1     skrll 	  /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
    212  1.1     skrll 	     this case and on some machines one insn instead of two.  */
    213  1.1     skrll 	  h ^= g;
    214  1.1     skrll 	}
    215  1.1     skrll     }
    216  1.1     skrll   return h & 0xffffffff;
    217  1.1     skrll }
    218  1.1     skrll 
    219  1.1     skrll /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function.  Do not change this function; you will
    220  1.1     skrll    cause invalid hash tables to be generated.  */
    221  1.1     skrll 
    222  1.1     skrll unsigned long
    223  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
    224  1.1     skrll {
    225  1.1     skrll   const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
    226  1.1     skrll   unsigned long h = 5381;
    227  1.1     skrll   unsigned char ch;
    228  1.1     skrll 
    229  1.1     skrll   while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
    230  1.1     skrll     h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
    231  1.1     skrll   return h & 0xffffffff;
    232  1.1     skrll }
    233  1.1     skrll 
    234  1.1     skrll /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
    235  1.1     skrll    the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID.  */
    236  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    237  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
    238  1.1     skrll 			 size_t object_size,
    239  1.3  christos 			 enum elf_target_id object_id)
    240  1.1     skrll {
    241  1.1     skrll   BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
    242  1.1     skrll   abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
    243  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
    244  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
    245  1.1     skrll 
    246  1.1     skrll   elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
    247  1.1     skrll   elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
    248  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
    249  1.1     skrll }
    250  1.1     skrll 
    251  1.1     skrll 
    252  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    253  1.3  christos bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
    254  1.1     skrll {
    255  1.3  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
    256  1.1     skrll   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
    257  1.3  christos 				  bed->target_id);
    258  1.1     skrll }
    259  1.1     skrll 
    260  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    261  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
    262  1.1     skrll {
    263  1.1     skrll   /* I think this can be done just like an object file.  */
    264  1.3  christos   return abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd);
    265  1.1     skrll }
    266  1.1     skrll 
    267  1.3  christos static char *
    268  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
    269  1.1     skrll {
    270  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
    271  1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
    272  1.1     skrll   file_ptr offset;
    273  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
    274  1.1     skrll 
    275  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
    276  1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp == 0
    277  1.1     skrll       || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
    278  1.1     skrll       || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
    279  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    280  1.1     skrll 
    281  1.1     skrll   shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
    282  1.1     skrll   if (shstrtab == NULL)
    283  1.1     skrll     {
    284  1.1     skrll       /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read.  */
    285  1.1     skrll       offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
    286  1.1     skrll       shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
    287  1.1     skrll 
    288  1.1     skrll       /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
    289  1.1     skrll 	 in case the string table is not terminated.  */
    290  1.1     skrll       if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
    291  1.3  christos 	  || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL
    292  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
    293  1.1     skrll 	shstrtab = NULL;
    294  1.1     skrll       else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
    295  1.1     skrll 	{
    296  1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
    297  1.1     skrll 	    bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
    298  1.1     skrll 	  shstrtab = NULL;
    299  1.1     skrll 	  /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
    300  1.1     skrll 	     trying.  Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
    301  1.1     skrll 	     the string table over and over.  */
    302  1.1     skrll 	  i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
    303  1.1     skrll 	}
    304  1.1     skrll       else
    305  1.1     skrll 	shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
    306  1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
    307  1.1     skrll     }
    308  1.1     skrll   return (char *) shstrtab;
    309  1.1     skrll }
    310  1.1     skrll 
    311  1.1     skrll char *
    312  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
    313  1.1     skrll 				 unsigned int shindex,
    314  1.1     skrll 				 unsigned int strindex)
    315  1.1     skrll {
    316  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
    317  1.1     skrll 
    318  1.1     skrll   if (strindex == 0)
    319  1.1     skrll     return "";
    320  1.1     skrll 
    321  1.1     skrll   if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
    322  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    323  1.1     skrll 
    324  1.1     skrll   hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
    325  1.1     skrll 
    326  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->contents == NULL
    327  1.1     skrll       && bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
    328  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    329  1.1     skrll 
    330  1.1     skrll   if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
    331  1.1     skrll     {
    332  1.1     skrll       unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
    333  1.1     skrll       (*_bfd_error_handler)
    334  1.1     skrll 	(_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %lu for section `%s'"),
    335  1.1     skrll 	 abfd, strindex, (unsigned long) hdr->sh_size,
    336  1.1     skrll 	 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
    337  1.1     skrll 	  ? ".shstrtab"
    338  1.1     skrll 	  : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
    339  1.3  christos       return NULL;
    340  1.1     skrll     }
    341  1.1     skrll 
    342  1.1     skrll   return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
    343  1.1     skrll }
    344  1.1     skrll 
    345  1.1     skrll /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
    346  1.1     skrll    SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
    347  1.1     skrll    symbol SYMOFFSET.  If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
    348  1.1     skrll    are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
    349  1.1     skrll    symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
    350  1.1     skrll    Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
    351  1.1     skrll    or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem.  */
    352  1.1     skrll 
    353  1.1     skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *
    354  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
    355  1.1     skrll 		      Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
    356  1.1     skrll 		      size_t symcount,
    357  1.1     skrll 		      size_t symoffset,
    358  1.1     skrll 		      Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
    359  1.1     skrll 		      void *extsym_buf,
    360  1.1     skrll 		      Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
    361  1.1     skrll {
    362  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
    363  1.1     skrll   void *alloc_ext;
    364  1.1     skrll   const bfd_byte *esym;
    365  1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
    366  1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
    367  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
    368  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
    369  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
    370  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
    371  1.1     skrll   size_t extsym_size;
    372  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type amt;
    373  1.1     skrll   file_ptr pos;
    374  1.1     skrll 
    375  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
    376  1.1     skrll     abort ();
    377  1.1     skrll 
    378  1.1     skrll   if (symcount == 0)
    379  1.1     skrll     return intsym_buf;
    380  1.1     skrll 
    381  1.1     skrll   /* Normal syms might have section extension entries.  */
    382  1.1     skrll   shndx_hdr = NULL;
    383  1.1     skrll   if (symtab_hdr == &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_hdr)
    384  1.1     skrll     shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
    385  1.1     skrll 
    386  1.1     skrll   /* Read the symbols.  */
    387  1.1     skrll   alloc_ext = NULL;
    388  1.1     skrll   alloc_extshndx = NULL;
    389  1.1     skrll   alloc_intsym = NULL;
    390  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
    391  1.1     skrll   extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
    392  1.1     skrll   amt = symcount * extsym_size;
    393  1.1     skrll   pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
    394  1.1     skrll   if (extsym_buf == NULL)
    395  1.1     skrll     {
    396  1.1     skrll       alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
    397  1.1     skrll       extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
    398  1.1     skrll     }
    399  1.1     skrll   if (extsym_buf == NULL
    400  1.1     skrll       || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
    401  1.1     skrll       || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
    402  1.1     skrll     {
    403  1.1     skrll       intsym_buf = NULL;
    404  1.1     skrll       goto out;
    405  1.1     skrll     }
    406  1.1     skrll 
    407  1.1     skrll   if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
    408  1.1     skrll     extshndx_buf = NULL;
    409  1.1     skrll   else
    410  1.1     skrll     {
    411  1.1     skrll       amt = symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
    412  1.1     skrll       pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
    413  1.1     skrll       if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
    414  1.1     skrll 	{
    415  1.3  christos 	  alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
    416  1.3  christos               bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
    417  1.1     skrll 	  extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
    418  1.1     skrll 	}
    419  1.1     skrll       if (extshndx_buf == NULL
    420  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
    421  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
    422  1.1     skrll 	{
    423  1.1     skrll 	  intsym_buf = NULL;
    424  1.1     skrll 	  goto out;
    425  1.1     skrll 	}
    426  1.1     skrll     }
    427  1.1     skrll 
    428  1.1     skrll   if (intsym_buf == NULL)
    429  1.1     skrll     {
    430  1.3  christos       alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
    431  1.3  christos           bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
    432  1.1     skrll       intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
    433  1.1     skrll       if (intsym_buf == NULL)
    434  1.1     skrll 	goto out;
    435  1.1     skrll     }
    436  1.1     skrll 
    437  1.1     skrll   /* Convert the symbols to internal form.  */
    438  1.1     skrll   isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
    439  1.3  christos   for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
    440  1.3  christos            shndx = extshndx_buf;
    441  1.1     skrll        isym < isymend;
    442  1.1     skrll        esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
    443  1.1     skrll     if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
    444  1.1     skrll       {
    445  1.1     skrll 	symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
    446  1.1     skrll 	(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B symbol number %lu references "
    447  1.1     skrll 				 "nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
    448  1.1     skrll 			       ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
    449  1.1     skrll 	if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
    450  1.1     skrll 	  free (alloc_intsym);
    451  1.1     skrll 	intsym_buf = NULL;
    452  1.1     skrll 	goto out;
    453  1.1     skrll       }
    454  1.1     skrll 
    455  1.1     skrll  out:
    456  1.1     skrll   if (alloc_ext != NULL)
    457  1.1     skrll     free (alloc_ext);
    458  1.1     skrll   if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
    459  1.1     skrll     free (alloc_extshndx);
    460  1.1     skrll 
    461  1.1     skrll   return intsym_buf;
    462  1.1     skrll }
    463  1.1     skrll 
    464  1.1     skrll /* Look up a symbol name.  */
    465  1.1     skrll const char *
    466  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
    467  1.1     skrll 		  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
    468  1.1     skrll 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
    469  1.1     skrll 		  asection *sym_sec)
    470  1.1     skrll {
    471  1.1     skrll   const char *name;
    472  1.1     skrll   unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
    473  1.1     skrll   unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
    474  1.1     skrll 
    475  1.1     skrll   if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
    476  1.1     skrll       /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing.  */
    477  1.1     skrll       && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
    478  1.1     skrll     {
    479  1.1     skrll       iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
    480  1.1     skrll       shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
    481  1.1     skrll     }
    482  1.1     skrll 
    483  1.1     skrll   name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
    484  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
    485  1.1     skrll     name = "(null)";
    486  1.1     skrll   else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
    487  1.1     skrll     name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
    488  1.1     skrll 
    489  1.1     skrll   return name;
    490  1.1     skrll }
    491  1.1     skrll 
    492  1.1     skrll /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
    493  1.1     skrll    sections.  The first element is the flags, the rest are section
    494  1.1     skrll    pointers.  */
    495  1.1     skrll 
    496  1.1     skrll typedef union elf_internal_group {
    497  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
    498  1.1     skrll   unsigned int flags;
    499  1.1     skrll } Elf_Internal_Group;
    500  1.1     skrll 
    501  1.1     skrll /* Return the name of the group signature symbol.  Why isn't the
    502  1.1     skrll    signature just a string?  */
    503  1.1     skrll 
    504  1.1     skrll static const char *
    505  1.1     skrll group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
    506  1.1     skrll {
    507  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
    508  1.1     skrll   unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
    509  1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
    510  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
    511  1.1     skrll 
    512  1.1     skrll   /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available.  Make sure
    513  1.1     skrll      that it is a symbol table section.  */
    514  1.1     skrll   if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
    515  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    516  1.1     skrll   hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
    517  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
    518  1.1     skrll       || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
    519  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    520  1.1     skrll 
    521  1.1     skrll   /* Go read the symbol.  */
    522  1.1     skrll   hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
    523  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
    524  1.1     skrll 			    &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
    525  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    526  1.1     skrll 
    527  1.1     skrll   return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
    528  1.1     skrll }
    529  1.1     skrll 
    530  1.1     skrll /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT.  */
    531  1.1     skrll 
    532  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
    533  1.1     skrll setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
    534  1.1     skrll {
    535  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
    536  1.1     skrll 
    537  1.1     skrll   /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections.  The count
    538  1.1     skrll      is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections.  */
    539  1.1     skrll   if (num_group == 0)
    540  1.1     skrll     {
    541  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, shnum;
    542  1.1     skrll 
    543  1.1     skrll       /* First count the number of groups.  If we have a SHT_GROUP
    544  1.1     skrll 	 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it.  */
    545  1.1     skrll       shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
    546  1.1     skrll       num_group = 0;
    547  1.1     skrll 
    548  1.1     skrll #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr)		\
    549  1.1     skrll 	(   (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP		\
    550  1.1     skrll 	 && (shdr)->sh_size >= (2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE)	\
    551  1.1     skrll 	 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE	\
    552  1.1     skrll 	 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
    553  1.1     skrll 
    554  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
    555  1.1     skrll 	{
    556  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
    557  1.1     skrll 
    558  1.1     skrll 	  if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr))
    559  1.1     skrll 	    num_group += 1;
    560  1.1     skrll 	}
    561  1.1     skrll 
    562  1.1     skrll       if (num_group == 0)
    563  1.1     skrll 	{
    564  1.1     skrll 	  num_group = (unsigned) -1;
    565  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
    566  1.1     skrll 	}
    567  1.1     skrll       else
    568  1.1     skrll 	{
    569  1.1     skrll 	  /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
    570  1.1     skrll 	     so we can find them quickly.  */
    571  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type amt;
    572  1.1     skrll 
    573  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
    574  1.3  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
    575  1.3  christos               bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
    576  1.1     skrll 	  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
    577  1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
    578  1.1     skrll 
    579  1.1     skrll 	  num_group = 0;
    580  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
    581  1.1     skrll 	    {
    582  1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
    583  1.1     skrll 
    584  1.1     skrll 	      if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr))
    585  1.1     skrll 		{
    586  1.1     skrll 		  unsigned char *src;
    587  1.1     skrll 		  Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
    588  1.1     skrll 
    589  1.1     skrll 		  /* Add to list of sections.  */
    590  1.1     skrll 		  elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
    591  1.1     skrll 		  num_group += 1;
    592  1.1     skrll 
    593  1.1     skrll 		  /* Read the raw contents.  */
    594  1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
    595  1.1     skrll 		  amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
    596  1.3  christos 		  shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
    597  1.3  christos                       bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
    598  1.1     skrll 		  /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers.  */
    599  1.1     skrll 		  if (shdr->contents == NULL)
    600  1.1     skrll 		    {
    601  1.1     skrll 		      _bfd_error_handler
    602  1.1     skrll 			(_("%B: Corrupt size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
    603  1.1     skrll 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    604  1.1     skrll 		      return FALSE;
    605  1.1     skrll 		    }
    606  1.1     skrll 
    607  1.1     skrll 		  memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
    608  1.1     skrll 
    609  1.1     skrll 		  if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
    610  1.1     skrll 		      || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
    611  1.1     skrll 			  != shdr->sh_size))
    612  1.1     skrll 		    return FALSE;
    613  1.1     skrll 
    614  1.1     skrll 		  /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
    615  1.1     skrll 		     array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
    616  1.1     skrll 		     to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
    617  1.1     skrll 		     pointers.  */
    618  1.1     skrll 		  src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
    619  1.1     skrll 		  dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
    620  1.1     skrll 		  while (1)
    621  1.1     skrll 		    {
    622  1.1     skrll 		      unsigned int idx;
    623  1.1     skrll 
    624  1.1     skrll 		      src -= 4;
    625  1.1     skrll 		      --dest;
    626  1.1     skrll 		      idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
    627  1.1     skrll 		      if (src == shdr->contents)
    628  1.1     skrll 			{
    629  1.1     skrll 			  dest->flags = idx;
    630  1.1     skrll 			  if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
    631  1.1     skrll 			    shdr->bfd_section->flags
    632  1.1     skrll 			      |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
    633  1.1     skrll 			  break;
    634  1.1     skrll 			}
    635  1.1     skrll 		      if (idx >= shnum)
    636  1.1     skrll 			{
    637  1.1     skrll 			  ((*_bfd_error_handler)
    638  1.1     skrll 			   (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd));
    639  1.1     skrll 			  idx = 0;
    640  1.1     skrll 			}
    641  1.1     skrll 		      dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
    642  1.1     skrll 		    }
    643  1.1     skrll 		}
    644  1.1     skrll 	    }
    645  1.1     skrll 	}
    646  1.1     skrll     }
    647  1.1     skrll 
    648  1.1     skrll   if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
    649  1.1     skrll     {
    650  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
    651  1.1     skrll 
    652  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
    653  1.1     skrll 	{
    654  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
    655  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
    656  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
    657  1.1     skrll 
    658  1.1     skrll 	  /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
    659  1.1     skrll 	     section is a member.  */
    660  1.1     skrll 	  while (--n_elt != 0)
    661  1.1     skrll 	    if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
    662  1.1     skrll 	      {
    663  1.1     skrll 		asection *s = NULL;
    664  1.1     skrll 
    665  1.1     skrll 		/* We are a member of this group.  Go looking through
    666  1.1     skrll 		   other members to see if any others are linked via
    667  1.1     skrll 		   next_in_group.  */
    668  1.1     skrll 		idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
    669  1.1     skrll 		n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
    670  1.1     skrll 		while (--n_elt != 0)
    671  1.1     skrll 		  if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
    672  1.1     skrll 		      && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
    673  1.1     skrll 		    break;
    674  1.1     skrll 		if (n_elt != 0)
    675  1.1     skrll 		  {
    676  1.1     skrll 		    /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
    677  1.1     skrll 		       insert current section in circular list.  */
    678  1.1     skrll 		    elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
    679  1.1     skrll 		    elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
    680  1.1     skrll 		    elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
    681  1.1     skrll 		  }
    682  1.1     skrll 		else
    683  1.1     skrll 		  {
    684  1.1     skrll 		    const char *gname;
    685  1.1     skrll 
    686  1.1     skrll 		    gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
    687  1.1     skrll 		    if (gname == NULL)
    688  1.1     skrll 		      return FALSE;
    689  1.1     skrll 		    elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
    690  1.1     skrll 
    691  1.1     skrll 		    /* Start a circular list with one element.  */
    692  1.1     skrll 		    elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
    693  1.1     skrll 		  }
    694  1.1     skrll 
    695  1.1     skrll 		/* If the group section has been created, point to the
    696  1.1     skrll 		   new member.  */
    697  1.1     skrll 		if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
    698  1.1     skrll 		  elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
    699  1.1     skrll 
    700  1.1     skrll 		i = num_group - 1;
    701  1.1     skrll 		break;
    702  1.1     skrll 	      }
    703  1.1     skrll 	}
    704  1.1     skrll     }
    705  1.1     skrll 
    706  1.1     skrll   if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
    707  1.1     skrll     {
    708  1.1     skrll       (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no group info for section %A"),
    709  1.1     skrll 			     abfd, newsect);
    710  1.1     skrll     }
    711  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
    712  1.1     skrll }
    713  1.1     skrll 
    714  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    715  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
    716  1.1     skrll {
    717  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
    718  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
    719  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
    720  1.1     skrll   asection *s;
    721  1.1     skrll 
    722  1.1     skrll   /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER.  */
    723  1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
    724  1.1     skrll     {
    725  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
    726  1.1     skrll       if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
    727  1.1     skrll 	{
    728  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
    729  1.1     skrll 	  /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
    730  1.1     skrll 	     not set the sh_link or sh_info fields.  Hence we could
    731  1.1     skrll 	     get the situation where elfsec is 0.  */
    732  1.1     skrll 	  if (elfsec == 0)
    733  1.1     skrll 	    {
    734  1.1     skrll 	      const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
    735  1.1     skrll 	      if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
    736  1.1     skrll 		bed->link_order_error_handler
    737  1.1     skrll 		  (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
    738  1.1     skrll 		   abfd, s);
    739  1.1     skrll 	    }
    740  1.1     skrll 	  else
    741  1.1     skrll 	    {
    742  1.3  christos 	      asection *linksec = NULL;
    743  1.1     skrll 
    744  1.1     skrll 	      if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
    745  1.1     skrll 		{
    746  1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
    747  1.3  christos 		  linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
    748  1.1     skrll 		}
    749  1.1     skrll 
    750  1.1     skrll 	      /* PR 1991, 2008:
    751  1.1     skrll 		 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
    752  1.1     skrll 		 sh_link.  We don't want to proceed.  */
    753  1.3  christos 	      if (linksec == NULL)
    754  1.1     skrll 		{
    755  1.1     skrll 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
    756  1.1     skrll 		    (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
    757  1.1     skrll 		     s->owner, s, elfsec);
    758  1.1     skrll 		  result = FALSE;
    759  1.1     skrll 		}
    760  1.1     skrll 
    761  1.3  christos 	      elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
    762  1.1     skrll 	    }
    763  1.1     skrll 	}
    764  1.1     skrll     }
    765  1.1     skrll 
    766  1.1     skrll   /* Process section groups.  */
    767  1.1     skrll   if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
    768  1.1     skrll     return result;
    769  1.1     skrll 
    770  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
    771  1.1     skrll     {
    772  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
    773  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
    774  1.1     skrll       unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
    775  1.1     skrll 
    776  1.1     skrll       while (--n_elt != 0)
    777  1.1     skrll 	if ((++idx)->shdr->bfd_section)
    778  1.1     skrll 	  elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
    779  1.1     skrll 	else if (idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
    780  1.1     skrll 		 || idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_REL)
    781  1.1     skrll 	  /* We won't include relocation sections in section groups in
    782  1.1     skrll 	     output object files. We adjust the group section size here
    783  1.1     skrll 	     so that relocatable link will work correctly when
    784  1.1     skrll 	     relocation sections are in section group in input object
    785  1.1     skrll 	     files.  */
    786  1.1     skrll 	  shdr->bfd_section->size -= 4;
    787  1.1     skrll 	else
    788  1.1     skrll 	  {
    789  1.1     skrll 	    /* There are some unknown sections in the group.  */
    790  1.1     skrll 	    (*_bfd_error_handler)
    791  1.1     skrll 	      (_("%B: unknown [%d] section `%s' in group [%s]"),
    792  1.1     skrll 	       abfd,
    793  1.1     skrll 	       (unsigned int) idx->shdr->sh_type,
    794  1.1     skrll 	       bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
    795  1.1     skrll 						(elf_elfheader (abfd)
    796  1.1     skrll 						 ->e_shstrndx),
    797  1.1     skrll 						idx->shdr->sh_name),
    798  1.1     skrll 	       shdr->bfd_section->name);
    799  1.1     skrll 	    result = FALSE;
    800  1.1     skrll 	  }
    801  1.1     skrll     }
    802  1.1     skrll   return result;
    803  1.1     skrll }
    804  1.1     skrll 
    805  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    806  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
    807  1.1     skrll {
    808  1.1     skrll   return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
    809  1.1     skrll }
    810  1.1     skrll 
    811  1.1     skrll /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section.  We store a pointer to the
    812  1.1     skrll    BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header.  */
    813  1.1     skrll 
    814  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    815  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
    816  1.1     skrll 				 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
    817  1.1     skrll 				 const char *name,
    818  1.1     skrll 				 int shindex)
    819  1.1     skrll {
    820  1.1     skrll   asection *newsect;
    821  1.1     skrll   flagword flags;
    822  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
    823  1.1     skrll 
    824  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
    825  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
    826  1.1     skrll 
    827  1.1     skrll   newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
    828  1.1     skrll   if (newsect == NULL)
    829  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
    830  1.1     skrll 
    831  1.1     skrll   hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
    832  1.1     skrll   elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
    833  1.1     skrll   elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
    834  1.1     skrll 
    835  1.1     skrll   /* Always use the real type/flags.  */
    836  1.1     skrll   elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
    837  1.1     skrll   elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
    838  1.1     skrll 
    839  1.1     skrll   newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
    840  1.1     skrll 
    841  1.1     skrll   if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
    842  1.1     skrll       || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
    843  1.1     skrll       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
    844  1.1     skrll 				      bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
    845  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
    846  1.1     skrll 
    847  1.1     skrll   flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
    848  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
    849  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
    850  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
    851  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE;
    852  1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
    853  1.1     skrll     {
    854  1.1     skrll       flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
    855  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
    856  1.1     skrll 	flags |= SEC_LOAD;
    857  1.1     skrll     }
    858  1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
    859  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_READONLY;
    860  1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
    861  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_CODE;
    862  1.1     skrll   else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
    863  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_DATA;
    864  1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
    865  1.1     skrll     {
    866  1.1     skrll       flags |= SEC_MERGE;
    867  1.1     skrll       newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
    868  1.1     skrll       if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
    869  1.1     skrll 	flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
    870  1.1     skrll     }
    871  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
    872  1.1     skrll     if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
    873  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
    874  1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
    875  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
    876  1.3  christos   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
    877  1.3  christos     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
    878  1.1     skrll 
    879  1.1     skrll   if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
    880  1.1     skrll     {
    881  1.1     skrll       /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
    882  1.1     skrll 	 not any sort of flag.  Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared.  */
    883  1.1     skrll       static const struct
    884  1.1     skrll 	{
    885  1.1     skrll 	  const char *name;
    886  1.1     skrll 	  int len;
    887  1.1     skrll 	} debug_sections [] =
    888  1.1     skrll 	{
    889  1.1     skrll 	  { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("debug") },	/* 'd' */
    890  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'e' */
    891  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'f' */
    892  1.1     skrll 	  { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("gnu.linkonce.wi.") },	/* 'g' */
    893  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'h' */
    894  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'i' */
    895  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'j' */
    896  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'k' */
    897  1.1     skrll 	  { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("line") },	/* 'l' */
    898  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'm' */
    899  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'n' */
    900  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'o' */
    901  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'p' */
    902  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'q' */
    903  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'r' */
    904  1.1     skrll 	  { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("stab") },	/* 's' */
    905  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 't' */
    906  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'u' */
    907  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'v' */
    908  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'w' */
    909  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'x' */
    910  1.1     skrll 	  { NULL,		 0  },	/* 'y' */
    911  1.1     skrll 	  { STRING_COMMA_LEN ("zdebug") }	/* 'z' */
    912  1.1     skrll 	};
    913  1.1     skrll 
    914  1.1     skrll       if (name [0] == '.')
    915  1.1     skrll 	{
    916  1.1     skrll 	  int i = name [1] - 'd';
    917  1.1     skrll 	  if (i >= 0
    918  1.1     skrll 	      && i < (int) ARRAY_SIZE (debug_sections)
    919  1.1     skrll 	      && debug_sections [i].name != NULL
    920  1.1     skrll 	      && strncmp (&name [1], debug_sections [i].name,
    921  1.1     skrll 			  debug_sections [i].len) == 0)
    922  1.1     skrll 	    flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
    923  1.1     skrll 	}
    924  1.1     skrll     }
    925  1.1     skrll 
    926  1.1     skrll   /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
    927  1.1     skrll      only link a single copy of the section.  This is used to support
    928  1.1     skrll      g++.  g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
    929  1.1     skrll      The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
    930  1.1     skrll      are permitted.  The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
    931  1.1     skrll      all but one of the sections.  */
    932  1.1     skrll   if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
    933  1.1     skrll       && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
    934  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
    935  1.1     skrll 
    936  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
    937  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
    938  1.1     skrll     if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
    939  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
    940  1.1     skrll 
    941  1.1     skrll   if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
    942  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
    943  1.1     skrll 
    944  1.1     skrll   /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
    945  1.1     skrll      separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
    946  1.1     skrll      PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD.  */
    947  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
    948  1.1     skrll     {
    949  1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *contents;
    950  1.1     skrll 
    951  1.1     skrll       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
    952  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
    953  1.1     skrll 
    954  1.1     skrll       elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size, -1);
    955  1.1     skrll       free (contents);
    956  1.1     skrll     }
    957  1.1     skrll 
    958  1.1     skrll   if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
    959  1.1     skrll     {
    960  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
    961  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, nload;
    962  1.1     skrll 
    963  1.1     skrll       /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
    964  1.1     skrll 	 p_paddr fields zero.  If we have such a binary with more than
    965  1.1     skrll 	 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
    966  1.1     skrll 	 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma.  */
    967  1.1     skrll       phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
    968  1.1     skrll       for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
    969  1.1     skrll 	if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
    970  1.1     skrll 	  break;
    971  1.1     skrll 	else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
    972  1.1     skrll 	  ++nload;
    973  1.1     skrll       if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
    974  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
    975  1.1     skrll 
    976  1.1     skrll       phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
    977  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
    978  1.1     skrll 	{
    979  1.3  christos 	  if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
    980  1.3  christos 		&& (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
    981  1.3  christos 	       || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
    982  1.3  christos 	      && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
    983  1.1     skrll 	    {
    984  1.1     skrll 	      if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
    985  1.1     skrll 		newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
    986  1.1     skrll 				+ hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
    987  1.1     skrll 	      else
    988  1.1     skrll 		/* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
    989  1.1     skrll 		   sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
    990  1.1     skrll 		   is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
    991  1.1     skrll 		   Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
    992  1.1     skrll 		   the segment LMA.  It is assumed that the
    993  1.1     skrll 		   segment will contain sections with contiguous
    994  1.1     skrll 		   LMAs, even if the VMAs are not.  */
    995  1.1     skrll 		newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
    996  1.1     skrll 				+ hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
    997  1.1     skrll 
    998  1.1     skrll 	      /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
    999  1.1     skrll 		 offsets whether a section with zero size should
   1000  1.1     skrll 		 be placed at the end of one segment or the
   1001  1.1     skrll 		 beginning of the next.  Decide based on vaddr.  */
   1002  1.1     skrll 	      if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
   1003  1.1     skrll 		  && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
   1004  1.1     skrll 		      <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
   1005  1.1     skrll 		break;
   1006  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1007  1.1     skrll 	}
   1008  1.1     skrll     }
   1009  1.1     skrll 
   1010  1.3  christos   /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
   1011  1.3  christos      .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set.  */
   1012  1.3  christos   if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
   1013  1.3  christos       && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
   1014  1.3  christos 	  || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
   1015  1.3  christos     {
   1016  1.3  christos       enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
   1017  1.3  christos       char *new_name;
   1018  1.3  christos 
   1019  1.3  christos       if (bfd_is_section_compressed (abfd, newsect))
   1020  1.3  christos 	{
   1021  1.3  christos 	  /* Compressed section.  Check if we should decompress.  */
   1022  1.3  christos 	  if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
   1023  1.3  christos 	    action = decompress;
   1024  1.3  christos 	}
   1025  1.3  christos       else
   1026  1.3  christos 	{
   1027  1.3  christos 	  /* Normal section.  Check if we should compress.  */
   1028  1.3  christos 	  if ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS))
   1029  1.3  christos 	    action = compress;
   1030  1.3  christos 	}
   1031  1.1     skrll 
   1032  1.3  christos       new_name = NULL;
   1033  1.3  christos       switch (action)
   1034  1.3  christos 	{
   1035  1.3  christos 	case nothing:
   1036  1.3  christos 	  break;
   1037  1.3  christos 	case compress:
   1038  1.3  christos 	  if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
   1039  1.3  christos 	    {
   1040  1.3  christos 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
   1041  1.3  christos 		(_("%B: unable to initialize commpress status for section %s"),
   1042  1.3  christos 		 abfd, name);
   1043  1.3  christos 	      return FALSE;
   1044  1.3  christos 	    }
   1045  1.3  christos 	  if (name[1] != 'z')
   1046  1.3  christos 	    {
   1047  1.3  christos 	      unsigned int len = strlen (name);
   1048  1.1     skrll 
   1049  1.3  christos 	      new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
   1050  1.3  christos 	      if (new_name == NULL)
   1051  1.3  christos 		return FALSE;
   1052  1.3  christos 	      new_name[0] = '.';
   1053  1.3  christos 	      new_name[1] = 'z';
   1054  1.3  christos 	      memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
   1055  1.3  christos 	    }
   1056  1.3  christos 	  break;
   1057  1.3  christos 	case decompress:
   1058  1.3  christos 	  if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
   1059  1.3  christos 	    {
   1060  1.3  christos 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
   1061  1.3  christos 		(_("%B: unable to initialize decommpress status for section %s"),
   1062  1.3  christos 		 abfd, name);
   1063  1.3  christos 	      return FALSE;
   1064  1.3  christos 	    }
   1065  1.3  christos 	  if (name[1] == 'z')
   1066  1.3  christos 	    {
   1067  1.3  christos 	      unsigned int len = strlen (name);
   1068  1.1     skrll 
   1069  1.3  christos 	      new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   1070  1.3  christos 	      if (new_name == NULL)
   1071  1.3  christos 		return FALSE;
   1072  1.3  christos 	      new_name[0] = '.';
   1073  1.3  christos 	      memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
   1074  1.3  christos 	    }
   1075  1.3  christos 	  break;
   1076  1.1     skrll 	}
   1077  1.3  christos       if (new_name != NULL)
   1078  1.3  christos 	bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
   1079  1.1     skrll     }
   1080  1.3  christos 
   1081  1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   1082  1.1     skrll }
   1083  1.1     skrll 
   1084  1.1     skrll const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] = {
   1085  1.1     skrll   "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
   1086  1.1     skrll   "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
   1087  1.1     skrll   "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
   1088  1.1     skrll };
   1089  1.1     skrll 
   1090  1.1     skrll /* ELF relocs are against symbols.  If we are producing relocatable
   1091  1.1     skrll    output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
   1092  1.1     skrll    has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
   1093  1.1     skrll    be against the same symbol.  In such a case, we don't want to
   1094  1.1     skrll    change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
   1095  1.1     skrll    all be done at final link time.  Rather than put special case code
   1096  1.1     skrll    into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
   1097  1.1     skrll    function.  It just short circuits the reloc if producing
   1098  1.1     skrll    relocatable output against an external symbol.  */
   1099  1.1     skrll 
   1100  1.1     skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
   1101  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1102  1.1     skrll 		       arelent *reloc_entry,
   1103  1.1     skrll 		       asymbol *symbol,
   1104  1.1     skrll 		       void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1105  1.1     skrll 		       asection *input_section,
   1106  1.1     skrll 		       bfd *output_bfd,
   1107  1.1     skrll 		       char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1108  1.1     skrll {
   1109  1.1     skrll   if (output_bfd != NULL
   1110  1.1     skrll       && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
   1111  1.1     skrll       && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
   1112  1.1     skrll 	  || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
   1113  1.1     skrll     {
   1114  1.1     skrll       reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
   1115  1.1     skrll       return bfd_reloc_ok;
   1116  1.1     skrll     }
   1117  1.1     skrll 
   1118  1.1     skrll   return bfd_reloc_continue;
   1119  1.1     skrll }
   1120  1.1     skrll 
   1121  1.1     skrll /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
   1123  1.1     skrll    another.  */
   1124  1.1     skrll 
   1125  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   1126  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   1127  1.1     skrll {
   1128  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   1129  1.1     skrll       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   1130  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   1131  1.1     skrll 
   1132  1.1     skrll   BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (obfd)
   1133  1.1     skrll 	      || (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
   1134  1.1     skrll 		  == elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags));
   1135  1.1     skrll 
   1136  1.1     skrll   elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
   1137  1.1     skrll   elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
   1138  1.1     skrll   elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
   1139  1.1     skrll 
   1140  1.1     skrll   /* Copy object attributes.  */
   1141  1.1     skrll   _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
   1142  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   1143  1.1     skrll }
   1144  1.1     skrll 
   1145  1.1     skrll static const char *
   1146  1.1     skrll get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
   1147  1.1     skrll {
   1148  1.1     skrll   const char *pt;
   1149  1.1     skrll   switch (p_type)
   1150  1.1     skrll     {
   1151  1.1     skrll     case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
   1152  1.1     skrll     case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
   1153  1.1     skrll     case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
   1154  1.1     skrll     case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
   1155  1.1     skrll     case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
   1156  1.1     skrll     case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
   1157  1.1     skrll     case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
   1158  1.1     skrll     case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
   1159  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
   1160  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
   1161  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
   1162  1.1     skrll     default: pt = NULL; break;
   1163  1.1     skrll     }
   1164  1.1     skrll   return pt;
   1165  1.1     skrll }
   1166  1.1     skrll 
   1167  1.1     skrll /* Print out the program headers.  */
   1168  1.1     skrll 
   1169  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   1170  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
   1171  1.3  christos {
   1172  1.1     skrll   FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
   1173  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   1174  1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   1175  1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
   1176  1.1     skrll 
   1177  1.1     skrll   p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   1178  1.1     skrll   if (p != NULL)
   1179  1.1     skrll     {
   1180  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, c;
   1181  1.1     skrll 
   1182  1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
   1183  1.1     skrll       c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
   1184  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
   1185  1.1     skrll 	{
   1186  1.1     skrll 	  const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
   1187  1.1     skrll 	  char buf[20];
   1188  1.1     skrll 
   1189  1.1     skrll 	  if (pt == NULL)
   1190  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1191  1.1     skrll 	      sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
   1192  1.1     skrll 	      pt = buf;
   1193  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1194  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "%8s off    0x", pt);
   1195  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
   1196  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
   1197  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
   1198  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
   1199  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
   1200  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
   1201  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "         filesz 0x");
   1202  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
   1203  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
   1204  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
   1205  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
   1206  1.1     skrll 		   (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
   1207  1.1     skrll 		   (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
   1208  1.1     skrll 		   (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
   1209  1.1     skrll 	  if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
   1210  1.1     skrll 	    fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
   1211  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "\n");
   1212  1.1     skrll 	}
   1213  1.1     skrll     }
   1214  1.1     skrll 
   1215  1.1     skrll   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
   1216  1.1     skrll   if (s != NULL)
   1217  1.1     skrll     {
   1218  1.1     skrll       unsigned int elfsec;
   1219  1.1     skrll       unsigned long shlink;
   1220  1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
   1221  1.1     skrll       size_t extdynsize;
   1222  1.1     skrll       void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
   1223  1.1     skrll 
   1224  1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
   1225  1.1     skrll 
   1226  1.1     skrll       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
   1227  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   1228  1.1     skrll 
   1229  1.1     skrll       elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
   1230  1.1     skrll       if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
   1231  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   1232  1.1     skrll       shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
   1233  1.1     skrll 
   1234  1.1     skrll       extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
   1235  1.1     skrll       swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
   1236  1.1     skrll 
   1237  1.1     skrll       extdyn = dynbuf;
   1238  1.1     skrll       extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
   1239  1.1     skrll       for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
   1240  1.1     skrll 	{
   1241  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   1242  1.1     skrll 	  const char *name = "";
   1243  1.1     skrll 	  char ab[20];
   1244  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_boolean stringp;
   1245  1.1     skrll 	  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   1246  1.1     skrll 
   1247  1.1     skrll 	  (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
   1248  1.1     skrll 
   1249  1.1     skrll 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
   1250  1.1     skrll 	    break;
   1251  1.1     skrll 
   1252  1.1     skrll 	  stringp = FALSE;
   1253  1.1     skrll 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
   1254  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1255  1.1     skrll 	    default:
   1256  1.1     skrll 	      if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
   1257  1.1     skrll 		name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
   1258  1.1     skrll 
   1259  1.1     skrll 	      if (!strcmp (name, ""))
   1260  1.1     skrll 		{
   1261  1.1     skrll 		  sprintf (ab, "0x%lx", (unsigned long) dyn.d_tag);
   1262  1.1     skrll 		  name = ab;
   1263  1.1     skrll 		}
   1264  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   1265  1.1     skrll 
   1266  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1267  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
   1268  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
   1269  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
   1270  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
   1271  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
   1272  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
   1273  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
   1274  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
   1275  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
   1276  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
   1277  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
   1278  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
   1279  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1280  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1281  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
   1282  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
   1283  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
   1284  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
   1285  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
   1286  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
   1287  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
   1288  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
   1289  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
   1290  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
   1291  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
   1292  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
   1293  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
   1294  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1295  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
   1296  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
   1297  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
   1298  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
   1299  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
   1300  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
   1301  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
   1302  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
   1303  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
   1304  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
   1305  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
   1306  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1307  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1308  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1309  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
   1310  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
   1311  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
   1312  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
   1313  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
   1314  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
   1315  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
   1316  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
   1317  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
   1318  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
   1319  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
   1320  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1321  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
   1322  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1323  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
   1324  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1325  1.1     skrll 
   1326  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "  %-20s ", name);
   1327  1.1     skrll 	  if (! stringp)
   1328  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1329  1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "0x");
   1330  1.1     skrll 	      bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
   1331  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1332  1.1     skrll 	  else
   1333  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1334  1.1     skrll 	      const char *string;
   1335  1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
   1336  1.1     skrll 
   1337  1.1     skrll 	      string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
   1338  1.1     skrll 	      if (string == NULL)
   1339  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return;
   1340  1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "%s", string);
   1341  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1342  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "\n");
   1343  1.1     skrll 	}
   1344  1.1     skrll 
   1345  1.1     skrll       free (dynbuf);
   1346  1.1     skrll       dynbuf = NULL;
   1347  1.1     skrll     }
   1348  1.1     skrll 
   1349  1.1     skrll   if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
   1350  1.1     skrll       || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
   1351  1.1     skrll     {
   1352  1.1     skrll       if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
   1353  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1354  1.1     skrll     }
   1355  1.1     skrll 
   1356  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
   1357  1.1     skrll     {
   1358  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
   1359  1.1     skrll 
   1360  1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
   1361  1.1     skrll       for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
   1362  1.1     skrll 	{
   1363  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
   1364  1.1     skrll 		   t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
   1365  1.1     skrll 		   t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
   1366  1.1     skrll 	  if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
   1367  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1368  1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
   1369  1.1     skrll 
   1370  1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "\t");
   1371  1.1     skrll 	      for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
   1372  1.1     skrll 		   a != NULL;
   1373  1.1     skrll 		   a = a->vda_nextptr)
   1374  1.1     skrll 		fprintf (f, "%s ",
   1375  1.1     skrll 			 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
   1376  1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "\n");
   1377  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1378  1.1     skrll 	}
   1379  1.1     skrll     }
   1380  1.1     skrll 
   1381  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
   1382  1.1     skrll     {
   1383  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
   1384  1.1     skrll 
   1385  1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
   1386  1.1     skrll       for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
   1387  1.1     skrll 	{
   1388  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
   1389  1.1     skrll 
   1390  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, _("  required from %s:\n"),
   1391  1.1     skrll 		   t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
   1392  1.1     skrll 	  for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
   1393  1.1     skrll 	    fprintf (f, "    0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
   1394  1.1     skrll 		     a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
   1395  1.1     skrll 		     a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
   1396  1.1     skrll 	}
   1397  1.1     skrll     }
   1398  1.1     skrll 
   1399  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   1400  1.1     skrll 
   1401  1.1     skrll  error_return:
   1402  1.1     skrll   if (dynbuf != NULL)
   1403  1.1     skrll     free (dynbuf);
   1404  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   1405  1.1     skrll }
   1406  1.1     skrll 
   1407  1.1     skrll /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol.  */
   1408  1.1     skrll 
   1409  1.1     skrll void
   1410  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
   1411  1.1     skrll 		      void *filep,
   1412  1.1     skrll 		      asymbol *symbol,
   1413  1.1     skrll 		      bfd_print_symbol_type how)
   1414  1.3  christos {
   1415  1.1     skrll   FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
   1416  1.1     skrll   switch (how)
   1417  1.1     skrll     {
   1418  1.1     skrll     case bfd_print_symbol_name:
   1419  1.1     skrll       fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
   1420  1.1     skrll       break;
   1421  1.1     skrll     case bfd_print_symbol_more:
   1422  1.1     skrll       fprintf (file, "elf ");
   1423  1.1     skrll       bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
   1424  1.1     skrll       fprintf (file, " %lx", (unsigned long) symbol->flags);
   1425  1.1     skrll       break;
   1426  1.1     skrll     case bfd_print_symbol_all:
   1427  1.1     skrll       {
   1428  1.1     skrll 	const char *section_name;
   1429  1.1     skrll 	const char *name = NULL;
   1430  1.1     skrll 	const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   1431  1.1     skrll 	unsigned char st_other;
   1432  1.1     skrll 	bfd_vma val;
   1433  1.1     skrll 
   1434  1.1     skrll 	section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
   1435  1.1     skrll 
   1436  1.1     skrll 	bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   1437  1.1     skrll 	if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
   1438  1.1     skrll 	  name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
   1439  1.1     skrll 
   1440  1.1     skrll 	if (name == NULL)
   1441  1.1     skrll 	  {
   1442  1.1     skrll 	    name = symbol->name;
   1443  1.1     skrll 	    bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
   1444  1.1     skrll 	  }
   1445  1.1     skrll 
   1446  1.1     skrll 	fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
   1447  1.1     skrll 	/* Print the "other" value for a symbol.  For common symbols,
   1448  1.1     skrll 	   we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
   1449  1.1     skrll 	   For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
   1450  1.1     skrll 	   we've printed the address; now print the size.  */
   1451  1.1     skrll 	if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
   1452  1.1     skrll 	  val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
   1453  1.1     skrll 	else
   1454  1.1     skrll 	  val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
   1455  1.1     skrll 	bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
   1456  1.1     skrll 
   1457  1.1     skrll 	/* If we have version information, print it.  */
   1458  1.1     skrll 	if (elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_section != 0
   1459  1.1     skrll 	    && (elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_section != 0
   1460  1.1     skrll 		|| elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_section != 0))
   1461  1.1     skrll 	  {
   1462  1.1     skrll 	    unsigned int vernum;
   1463  1.1     skrll 	    const char *version_string;
   1464  1.1     skrll 
   1465  1.1     skrll 	    vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version & VERSYM_VERSION;
   1466  1.1     skrll 
   1467  1.1     skrll 	    if (vernum == 0)
   1468  1.1     skrll 	      version_string = "";
   1469  1.1     skrll 	    else if (vernum == 1)
   1470  1.1     skrll 	      version_string = "Base";
   1471  1.1     skrll 	    else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
   1472  1.1     skrll 	      version_string =
   1473  1.1     skrll 		elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
   1474  1.1     skrll 	    else
   1475  1.1     skrll 	      {
   1476  1.1     skrll 		Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
   1477  1.1     skrll 
   1478  1.1     skrll 		version_string = "";
   1479  1.1     skrll 		for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
   1480  1.1     skrll 		     t != NULL;
   1481  1.1     skrll 		     t = t->vn_nextref)
   1482  1.1     skrll 		  {
   1483  1.1     skrll 		    Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
   1484  1.1     skrll 
   1485  1.1     skrll 		    for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
   1486  1.1     skrll 		      {
   1487  1.1     skrll 			if (a->vna_other == vernum)
   1488  1.1     skrll 			  {
   1489  1.1     skrll 			    version_string = a->vna_nodename;
   1490  1.1     skrll 			    break;
   1491  1.1     skrll 			  }
   1492  1.1     skrll 		      }
   1493  1.1     skrll 		  }
   1494  1.1     skrll 	      }
   1495  1.1     skrll 
   1496  1.1     skrll 	    if ((((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version & VERSYM_HIDDEN) == 0)
   1497  1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (file, "  %-11s", version_string);
   1498  1.1     skrll 	    else
   1499  1.1     skrll 	      {
   1500  1.1     skrll 		int i;
   1501  1.1     skrll 
   1502  1.1     skrll 		fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
   1503  1.1     skrll 		for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
   1504  1.1     skrll 		  putc (' ', file);
   1505  1.1     skrll 	      }
   1506  1.1     skrll 	  }
   1507  1.1     skrll 
   1508  1.1     skrll 	/* If the st_other field is not zero, print it.  */
   1509  1.1     skrll 	st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
   1510  1.1     skrll 
   1511  1.1     skrll 	switch (st_other)
   1512  1.1     skrll 	  {
   1513  1.1     skrll 	  case 0: break;
   1514  1.1     skrll 	  case STV_INTERNAL:  fprintf (file, " .internal");  break;
   1515  1.1     skrll 	  case STV_HIDDEN:    fprintf (file, " .hidden");    break;
   1516  1.1     skrll 	  case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
   1517  1.1     skrll 	  default:
   1518  1.1     skrll 	    /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
   1519  1.1     skrll 	       everything hex.  */
   1520  1.1     skrll 	    fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
   1521  1.1     skrll 	  }
   1522  1.1     skrll 
   1523  1.1     skrll 	fprintf (file, " %s", name);
   1524  1.1     skrll       }
   1525  1.1     skrll       break;
   1526  1.1     skrll     }
   1527  1.1     skrll }
   1528  1.1     skrll 
   1529  1.1     skrll /* Allocate an ELF string table--force the first byte to be zero.  */
   1530  1.1     skrll 
   1531  1.1     skrll struct bfd_strtab_hash *
   1532  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_stringtab_init (void)
   1533  1.1     skrll {
   1534  1.1     skrll   struct bfd_strtab_hash *ret;
   1535  1.1     skrll 
   1536  1.1     skrll   ret = _bfd_stringtab_init ();
   1537  1.1     skrll   if (ret != NULL)
   1538  1.1     skrll     {
   1539  1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type loc;
   1540  1.1     skrll 
   1541  1.1     skrll       loc = _bfd_stringtab_add (ret, "", TRUE, FALSE);
   1542  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (loc == 0 || loc == (bfd_size_type) -1);
   1543  1.1     skrll       if (loc == (bfd_size_type) -1)
   1544  1.1     skrll 	{
   1545  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_stringtab_free (ret);
   1546  1.1     skrll 	  ret = NULL;
   1547  1.1     skrll 	}
   1548  1.1     skrll     }
   1549  1.1     skrll   return ret;
   1550  1.1     skrll }
   1551  1.1     skrll 
   1552  1.1     skrll /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
   1554  1.1     skrll 
   1555  1.1     skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header.  */
   1556  1.1     skrll 
   1557  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   1558  1.1     skrll bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
   1559  1.1     skrll {
   1560  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   1561  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
   1562  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   1563  1.1     skrll   const char *name;
   1564  1.1     skrll 
   1565  1.1     skrll   if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
   1566  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   1567  1.1     skrll 
   1568  1.1     skrll   hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
   1569  1.1     skrll   ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   1570  1.1     skrll   name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
   1571  1.1     skrll 					  hdr->sh_name);
   1572  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   1573  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   1574  1.1     skrll 
   1575  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   1576  1.1     skrll   switch (hdr->sh_type)
   1577  1.1     skrll     {
   1578  1.1     skrll     case SHT_NULL:
   1579  1.1     skrll       /* Inactive section. Throw it away.  */
   1580  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   1581  1.1     skrll 
   1582  1.1     skrll     case SHT_PROGBITS:	/* Normal section with contents.  */
   1583  1.1     skrll     case SHT_NOBITS:	/* .bss section.  */
   1584  1.1     skrll     case SHT_HASH:	/* .hash section.  */
   1585  1.1     skrll     case SHT_NOTE:	/* .note section.  */
   1586  1.1     skrll     case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:	/* .init_array section.  */
   1587  1.1     skrll     case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:	/* .fini_array section.  */
   1588  1.1     skrll     case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:	/* .preinit_array section.  */
   1589  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:	/* .gnu.liblist section.  */
   1590  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_HASH:		/* .gnu.hash section.  */
   1591  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   1592  1.1     skrll 
   1593  1.1     skrll     case SHT_DYNAMIC:	/* Dynamic linking information.  */
   1594  1.3  christos       if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   1595  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   1596  1.3  christos       if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
   1597  1.3  christos 	{
   1598  1.3  christos 	  /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
   1599  1.3  christos 	     field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER.  */
   1600  1.3  christos 	  switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
   1601  1.3  christos 	    {
   1602  1.3  christos 	    case bfd_arch_i386:
   1603  1.3  christos 	    case bfd_arch_sparc:
   1604  1.3  christos 	      if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
   1605  1.3  christos 		  || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
   1606  1.3  christos 		break;
   1607  1.3  christos 	      /* Otherwise fall through.  */
   1608  1.3  christos 	    default:
   1609  1.3  christos 	      return FALSE;
   1610  1.3  christos 	    }
   1611  1.1     skrll 	}
   1612  1.3  christos       else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
   1613  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1614  1.1     skrll       else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
   1615  1.1     skrll 	{
   1616  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
   1617  1.1     skrll 
   1618  1.1     skrll 	  /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
   1619  1.1     skrll 	     sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section.  Find the
   1620  1.1     skrll 	     string table for the ".dynsym" section instead.  */
   1621  1.1     skrll 	  if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
   1622  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1623  1.1     skrll 	      dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
   1624  1.1     skrll 	      hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
   1625  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1626  1.1     skrll 	  else
   1627  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1628  1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int i, num_sec;
   1629  1.1     skrll 
   1630  1.1     skrll 	      num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   1631  1.1     skrll 	      for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
   1632  1.1     skrll 		{
   1633  1.1     skrll 		  dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   1634  1.1     skrll 		  if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
   1635  1.1     skrll 		    {
   1636  1.1     skrll 		      hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
   1637  1.1     skrll 		      break;
   1638  1.1     skrll 		    }
   1639  1.1     skrll 		}
   1640  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1641  1.1     skrll 	}
   1642  1.1     skrll       break;
   1643  1.1     skrll 
   1644  1.1     skrll     case SHT_SYMTAB:		/* A symbol table */
   1645  1.1     skrll       if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
   1646  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   1647  1.1     skrll 
   1648  1.2     skrll       if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
   1649  1.2     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1650  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
   1651  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1652  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0);
   1653  1.1     skrll       elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
   1654  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr = *hdr;
   1655  1.1     skrll       elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   1656  1.1     skrll       abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
   1657  1.1     skrll 
   1658  1.1     skrll       /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table.  If
   1659  1.1     skrll 	 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
   1660  1.1     skrll 	 treat this section as a BFD section.  We can not base the
   1661  1.1     skrll 	 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
   1662  1.1     skrll 	 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
   1663  1.1     skrll 	 linker.  */
   1664  1.1     skrll       if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
   1665  1.1     skrll 	  && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
   1666  1.1     skrll 	  && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   1667  1.1     skrll 						shindex))
   1668  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1669  1.1     skrll 
   1670  1.1     skrll       /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
   1671  1.1     skrll 	 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well.  It
   1672  1.1     skrll 	 is most likely specified by the next section header.  */
   1673  1.1     skrll       if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_symtab_shndx (abfd)]->sh_link != shindex)
   1674  1.1     skrll 	{
   1675  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int i, num_sec;
   1676  1.1     skrll 
   1677  1.1     skrll 	  num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   1678  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
   1679  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1680  1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   1681  1.1     skrll 	      if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
   1682  1.1     skrll 		  && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
   1683  1.1     skrll 		break;
   1684  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1685  1.1     skrll 	  if (i == num_sec)
   1686  1.1     skrll 	    for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
   1687  1.1     skrll 	      {
   1688  1.1     skrll 		Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   1689  1.1     skrll 		if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
   1690  1.1     skrll 		    && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
   1691  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   1692  1.1     skrll 	      }
   1693  1.1     skrll 	  if (i != shindex)
   1694  1.1     skrll 	    return bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
   1695  1.1     skrll 	}
   1696  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   1697  1.1     skrll 
   1698  1.1     skrll     case SHT_DYNSYM:		/* A dynamic symbol table */
   1699  1.1     skrll       if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
   1700  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   1701  1.1     skrll 
   1702  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
   1703  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1704  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0);
   1705  1.1     skrll       elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
   1706  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
   1707  1.1     skrll       elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
   1708  1.1     skrll       abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
   1709  1.1     skrll 
   1710  1.1     skrll       /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
   1711  1.1     skrll 	 section, so that objcopy can handle it.  */
   1712  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   1713  1.1     skrll 
   1714  1.1     skrll     case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX:	/* Symbol section indices when >64k sections */
   1715  1.1     skrll       if (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == shindex)
   1716  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   1717  1.1     skrll 
   1718  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) == 0);
   1719  1.1     skrll       elf_symtab_shndx (abfd) = shindex;
   1720  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr = *hdr;
   1721  1.1     skrll       elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
   1722  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   1723  1.1     skrll 
   1724  1.1     skrll     case SHT_STRTAB:		/* A string table */
   1725  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
   1726  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   1727  1.1     skrll       if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
   1728  1.1     skrll 	{
   1729  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
   1730  1.1     skrll 	  elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
   1731  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   1732  1.1     skrll 	}
   1733  1.1     skrll       if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
   1734  1.1     skrll 	{
   1735  1.1     skrll 	symtab_strtab:
   1736  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
   1737  1.1     skrll 	  elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
   1738  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   1739  1.1     skrll 	}
   1740  1.1     skrll       if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
   1741  1.1     skrll 	{
   1742  1.1     skrll 	dynsymtab_strtab:
   1743  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
   1744  1.1     skrll 	  hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
   1745  1.1     skrll 	  elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
   1746  1.1     skrll 	  /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
   1747  1.1     skrll 	     can handle it.  */
   1748  1.1     skrll 	  return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   1749  1.1     skrll 						  shindex);
   1750  1.1     skrll 	}
   1751  1.1     skrll 
   1752  1.1     skrll       /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
   1753  1.1     skrll 	 regular section.  We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
   1754  1.1     skrll 	 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above.  */
   1755  1.1     skrll       if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   1756  1.1     skrll 	{
   1757  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int i, num_sec;
   1758  1.1     skrll 
   1759  1.1     skrll 	  num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   1760  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
   1761  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1762  1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   1763  1.1     skrll 	      if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
   1764  1.1     skrll 		{
   1765  1.1     skrll 		  /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects.  */
   1766  1.1     skrll 		  if (i == shindex)
   1767  1.1     skrll 		    return FALSE;
   1768  1.1     skrll 		  if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
   1769  1.1     skrll 		    return FALSE;
   1770  1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
   1771  1.1     skrll 		    goto symtab_strtab;
   1772  1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
   1773  1.1     skrll 		    goto dynsymtab_strtab;
   1774  1.1     skrll 		}
   1775  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1776  1.1     skrll 	}
   1777  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   1778  1.1     skrll 
   1779  1.1     skrll     case SHT_REL:
   1780  1.1     skrll     case SHT_RELA:
   1781  1.1     skrll       /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections!  */
   1782  1.3  christos       {
   1783  1.1     skrll 	asection *target_sect;
   1784  1.3  christos 	Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
   1785  1.3  christos 	unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   1786  1.1     skrll 	struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
   1787  1.1     skrll 	bfd_size_type amt;
   1788  1.1     skrll 
   1789  1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_entsize
   1790  1.1     skrll 	    != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
   1791  1.1     skrll 				? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
   1792  1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   1793  1.1     skrll 
   1794  1.1     skrll 	/* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing.  */
   1795  1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
   1796  1.1     skrll 	  {
   1797  1.1     skrll 	    ((*_bfd_error_handler)
   1798  1.1     skrll 	     (_("%B: invalid link %lu for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
   1799  1.1     skrll 	      abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex));
   1800  1.1     skrll 	    return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   1801  1.1     skrll 						    shindex);
   1802  1.1     skrll 	  }
   1803  1.1     skrll 
   1804  1.1     skrll 	/* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
   1805  1.1     skrll 	   libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
   1806  1.1     skrll 	   bogus sh_link fields.  It would be nice if we could just
   1807  1.1     skrll 	   reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
   1808  1.3  christos 	   them.  We scan through the section headers; if we find only
   1809  1.3  christos 	   one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
   1810  1.3  christos 	   to it.  I hope this doesn't break anything.
   1811  1.3  christos 
   1812  1.3  christos 	   Don't do it on executable nor shared library.  */
   1813  1.1     skrll 	if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
   1814  1.1     skrll 	    && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
   1815  1.1     skrll 	    && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
   1816  1.1     skrll 	  {
   1817  1.1     skrll 	    unsigned int scan;
   1818  1.1     skrll 	    int found;
   1819  1.1     skrll 
   1820  1.1     skrll 	    found = 0;
   1821  1.1     skrll 	    for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
   1822  1.1     skrll 	      {
   1823  1.1     skrll 		if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
   1824  1.1     skrll 		    || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
   1825  1.1     skrll 		  {
   1826  1.1     skrll 		    if (found != 0)
   1827  1.1     skrll 		      {
   1828  1.1     skrll 			found = 0;
   1829  1.1     skrll 			break;
   1830  1.1     skrll 		      }
   1831  1.1     skrll 		    found = scan;
   1832  1.1     skrll 		  }
   1833  1.1     skrll 	      }
   1834  1.1     skrll 	    if (found != 0)
   1835  1.1     skrll 	      hdr->sh_link = found;
   1836  1.1     skrll 	  }
   1837  1.1     skrll 
   1838  1.1     skrll 	/* Get the symbol table.  */
   1839  1.1     skrll 	if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
   1840  1.1     skrll 	     || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
   1841  1.1     skrll 	    && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
   1842  1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   1843  1.1     skrll 
   1844  1.1     skrll 	/* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
   1845  1.1     skrll 	   don't treat it as a reloc section.  BFD can't adequately
   1846  1.1     skrll 	   represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
   1847  1.3  christos 	   try.  We just present it as a normal section.  We also
   1848  1.3  christos 	   can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
   1849  1.1     skrll 	   section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
   1850  1.3  christos 	   sh_link points to the null section.  */
   1851  1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
   1852  1.1     skrll 	    || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
   1853  1.1     skrll 	    || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
   1854  1.1     skrll 	    || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
   1855  1.1     skrll 	    || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
   1856  1.1     skrll 	    || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   1857  1.1     skrll 	  return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   1858  1.1     skrll 						  shindex);
   1859  1.1     skrll 
   1860  1.1     skrll 	if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
   1861  1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   1862  1.1     skrll 	target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
   1863  1.1     skrll 	if (target_sect == NULL)
   1864  1.3  christos 	  return FALSE;
   1865  1.3  christos 
   1866  1.3  christos 	esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
   1867  1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   1868  1.3  christos 	  p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
   1869  1.3  christos 	else
   1870  1.3  christos 	  p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
   1871  1.3  christos 
   1872  1.3  christos 	BFD_ASSERT (*p_hdr == NULL);
   1873  1.3  christos 	amt = sizeof (*hdr2);
   1874  1.3  christos 	hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   1875  1.1     skrll 	if (hdr2 == NULL)
   1876  1.3  christos 	  return FALSE;
   1877  1.1     skrll 	*hdr2 = *hdr;
   1878  1.1     skrll 	*p_hdr = hdr2;
   1879  1.1     skrll 	elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
   1880  1.1     skrll 	target_sect->reloc_count += NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
   1881  1.1     skrll 	target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
   1882  1.1     skrll 	target_sect->relocation = NULL;
   1883  1.1     skrll 	target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
   1884  1.1     skrll 	/* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
   1885  1.3  christos 	   its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety.  */
   1886  1.3  christos 	if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   1887  1.3  christos 	  {
   1888  1.3  christos 	    if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   1889  1.1     skrll 	      target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
   1890  1.1     skrll 	  }
   1891  1.1     skrll 	abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
   1892  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   1893  1.1     skrll       }
   1894  1.1     skrll 
   1895  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_verdef:
   1896  1.1     skrll       elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
   1897  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
   1898  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   1899  1.1     skrll 
   1900  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_versym:
   1901  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
   1902  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1903  1.1     skrll       elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
   1904  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
   1905  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   1906  1.1     skrll 
   1907  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_verneed:
   1908  1.1     skrll       elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
   1909  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
   1910  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   1911  1.1     skrll 
   1912  1.1     skrll     case SHT_SHLIB:
   1913  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   1914  1.1     skrll 
   1915  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GROUP:
   1916  1.1     skrll       if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr))
   1917  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1918  1.1     skrll       if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   1919  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1920  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->contents != NULL)
   1921  1.1     skrll 	{
   1922  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) hdr->contents;
   1923  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int n_elt = hdr->sh_size / GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
   1924  1.1     skrll 	  asection *s;
   1925  1.1     skrll 
   1926  1.1     skrll 	  if (idx->flags & GRP_COMDAT)
   1927  1.1     skrll 	    hdr->bfd_section->flags
   1928  1.1     skrll 	      |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
   1929  1.1     skrll 
   1930  1.1     skrll 	  /* We try to keep the same section order as it comes in.  */
   1931  1.1     skrll 	  idx += n_elt;
   1932  1.1     skrll 	  while (--n_elt != 0)
   1933  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1934  1.1     skrll 	      --idx;
   1935  1.1     skrll 
   1936  1.1     skrll 	      if (idx->shdr != NULL
   1937  1.1     skrll 		  && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
   1938  1.1     skrll 		  && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
   1939  1.1     skrll 		{
   1940  1.1     skrll 		  elf_next_in_group (hdr->bfd_section) = s;
   1941  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   1942  1.1     skrll 		}
   1943  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1944  1.1     skrll 	}
   1945  1.1     skrll       break;
   1946  1.1     skrll 
   1947  1.1     skrll     default:
   1948  1.1     skrll       /* Possibly an attributes section.  */
   1949  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
   1950  1.1     skrll 	  || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
   1951  1.1     skrll 	{
   1952  1.1     skrll 	  if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   1953  1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
   1954  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
   1955  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   1956  1.1     skrll 	}
   1957  1.1     skrll 
   1958  1.1     skrll       /* Check for any processor-specific section types.  */
   1959  1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   1960  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   1961  1.1     skrll 
   1962  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
   1963  1.1     skrll 	{
   1964  1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   1965  1.1     skrll 	    /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
   1966  1.1     skrll 	       for applications?  */
   1967  1.1     skrll 	    (*_bfd_error_handler)
   1968  1.1     skrll 	      (_("%B: don't know how to handle allocated, application "
   1969  1.1     skrll 		 "specific section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
   1970  1.1     skrll 	       abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
   1971  1.1     skrll 	  else
   1972  1.1     skrll 	    /* Allow sections reserved for applications.  */
   1973  1.1     skrll 	    return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   1974  1.1     skrll 						    shindex);
   1975  1.1     skrll 	}
   1976  1.1     skrll       else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
   1977  1.1     skrll 	       && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
   1978  1.1     skrll 	/* FIXME: We should handle this section.  */
   1979  1.1     skrll 	(*_bfd_error_handler)
   1980  1.1     skrll 	  (_("%B: don't know how to handle processor specific section "
   1981  1.1     skrll 	     "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
   1982  1.1     skrll 	   abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
   1983  1.1     skrll       else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
   1984  1.1     skrll 	{
   1985  1.1     skrll 	  /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections.  */
   1986  1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
   1987  1.1     skrll 	    /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
   1988  1.1     skrll 	       required to correctly process the section and the file should
   1989  1.1     skrll 	       be rejected with an error message.  */
   1990  1.1     skrll 	    (*_bfd_error_handler)
   1991  1.1     skrll 	      (_("%B: don't know how to handle OS specific section "
   1992  1.1     skrll 		 "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
   1993  1.1     skrll 	       abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
   1994  1.1     skrll 	  else
   1995  1.1     skrll 	    /* Otherwise it should be processed.  */
   1996  1.1     skrll 	    return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   1997  1.1     skrll 	}
   1998  1.1     skrll       else
   1999  1.1     skrll 	/* FIXME: We should handle this section.  */
   2000  1.1     skrll 	(*_bfd_error_handler)
   2001  1.1     skrll 	  (_("%B: don't know how to handle section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
   2002  1.1     skrll 	   abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
   2003  1.1     skrll 
   2004  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   2005  1.1     skrll     }
   2006  1.1     skrll 
   2007  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   2008  1.3  christos }
   2009  1.1     skrll 
   2010  1.3  christos /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX.  */
   2011  1.3  christos 
   2012  1.3  christos Elf_Internal_Sym *
   2013  1.3  christos bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
   2014  1.1     skrll 		       bfd *abfd,
   2015  1.1     skrll 		       unsigned long r_symndx)
   2016  1.1     skrll {
   2017  1.1     skrll   unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
   2018  1.1     skrll 
   2019  1.1     skrll   if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
   2020  1.1     skrll     {
   2021  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   2022  1.1     skrll       unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
   2023  1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
   2024  1.1     skrll 
   2025  1.3  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   2026  1.1     skrll       if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
   2027  1.1     skrll 				&cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
   2028  1.1     skrll 	return NULL;
   2029  1.1     skrll 
   2030  1.1     skrll       if (cache->abfd != abfd)
   2031  1.1     skrll 	{
   2032  1.1     skrll 	  memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
   2033  1.1     skrll 	  cache->abfd = abfd;
   2034  1.1     skrll 	}
   2035  1.1     skrll       cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
   2036  1.3  christos     }
   2037  1.1     skrll 
   2038  1.1     skrll   return &cache->sym[ent];
   2039  1.1     skrll }
   2040  1.1     skrll 
   2041  1.1     skrll /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
   2042  1.1     skrll    section.  */
   2043  1.3  christos 
   2044  1.1     skrll asection *
   2045  1.3  christos bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
   2046  1.1     skrll {
   2047  1.3  christos   if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
   2048  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2049  1.1     skrll   return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
   2050  1.1     skrll }
   2051  1.1     skrll 
   2052  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
   2053  1.1     skrll {
   2054  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2055  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                   0,  0, 0,            0 }
   2056  1.1     skrll };
   2057  1.1     skrll 
   2058  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
   2059  1.1     skrll {
   2060  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2061  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                       0, 0, 0,            0 }
   2062  1.1     skrll };
   2063  1.1     skrll 
   2064  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
   2065  1.1     skrll {
   2066  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"),         -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2067  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"),         0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2068  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"),         0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2069  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2070  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2071  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"),  0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2072  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2073  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"),       0, SHT_DYNAMIC,  SHF_ALLOC },
   2074  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"),        0, SHT_STRTAB,   SHF_ALLOC },
   2075  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"),        0, SHT_DYNSYM,   SHF_ALLOC },
   2076  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                      0,        0, 0,            0 }
   2077  1.1     skrll };
   2078  1.1     skrll 
   2079  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
   2080  1.1     skrll {
   2081  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"),       0, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2082  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), 0, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2083  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                          0, 0, 0,              0 }
   2084  1.1     skrll };
   2085  1.1     skrll 
   2086  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
   2087  1.3  christos {
   2088  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS,      SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2089  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"),       -1, SHT_PROGBITS,    SHF_EXCLUDE },
   2090  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"),             0, SHT_PROGBITS,    SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2091  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"),     0, SHT_GNU_versym,  0 },
   2092  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"),   0, SHT_GNU_verdef,  0 },
   2093  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"),   0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
   2094  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"),     0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
   2095  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"),    0, SHT_RELA,        SHF_ALLOC },
   2096  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"),        0, SHT_GNU_HASH,    SHF_ALLOC },
   2097  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                        0,        0, 0,               0 }
   2098  1.1     skrll };
   2099  1.1     skrll 
   2100  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
   2101  1.1     skrll {
   2102  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH,     SHF_ALLOC },
   2103  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                    0, 0, 0,            0 }
   2104  1.1     skrll };
   2105  1.1     skrll 
   2106  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
   2107  1.1     skrll {
   2108  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"),       0, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2109  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), 0, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2110  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"),     0, SHT_PROGBITS,   0 },
   2111  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                      0,     0, 0,              0 }
   2112  1.1     skrll };
   2113  1.1     skrll 
   2114  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
   2115  1.1     skrll {
   2116  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2117  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                    0, 0, 0,            0 }
   2118  1.1     skrll };
   2119  1.1     skrll 
   2120  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
   2121  1.1     skrll {
   2122  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2123  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"),          -1, SHT_NOTE,     0 },
   2124  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                    0,           0, 0,            0 }
   2125  1.1     skrll };
   2126  1.1     skrll 
   2127  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
   2128  1.1     skrll {
   2129  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), 0, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2130  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),           0, SHT_PROGBITS,      SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2131  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                   0,           0, 0,                 0 }
   2132  1.1     skrll };
   2133  1.1     skrll 
   2134  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
   2135  1.1     skrll {
   2136  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   2137  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   2138  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"),   -1, SHT_RELA,     0 },
   2139  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"),    -1, SHT_REL,      0 },
   2140  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                   0,     0, 0,            0 }
   2141  1.1     skrll };
   2142  1.1     skrll 
   2143  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
   2144  1.1     skrll {
   2145  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
   2146  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"),   0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
   2147  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"),   0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
   2148  1.1     skrll   /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
   2149  1.1     skrll      this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix).  */
   2150  1.1     skrll   { ".stabstr",			5,  3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
   2151  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                       0,  0, 0,          0 }
   2152  1.1     skrll };
   2153  1.1     skrll 
   2154  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
   2155  1.1     skrll {
   2156  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"),  -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2157  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"),  -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
   2158  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
   2159  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                     0,  0, 0,            0 }
   2160  1.1     skrll };
   2161  1.1     skrll 
   2162  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
   2163  1.1     skrll {
   2164  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2165  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2166  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"),  0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2167  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2168  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                     0,  0, 0,            0 }
   2169  1.1     skrll };
   2170  1.1     skrll 
   2171  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *special_sections[] =
   2172  1.1     skrll {
   2173  1.1     skrll   special_sections_b,		/* 'b' */
   2174  1.1     skrll   special_sections_c,		/* 'c' */
   2175  1.1     skrll   special_sections_d,		/* 'd' */
   2176  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'e' */
   2177  1.1     skrll   special_sections_f,		/* 'f' */
   2178  1.1     skrll   special_sections_g,		/* 'g' */
   2179  1.1     skrll   special_sections_h,		/* 'h' */
   2180  1.1     skrll   special_sections_i,		/* 'i' */
   2181  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'j' */
   2182  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'k' */
   2183  1.1     skrll   special_sections_l,		/* 'l' */
   2184  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'm' */
   2185  1.1     skrll   special_sections_n,		/* 'n' */
   2186  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'o' */
   2187  1.1     skrll   special_sections_p,		/* 'p' */
   2188  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'q' */
   2189  1.1     skrll   special_sections_r,		/* 'r' */
   2190  1.1     skrll   special_sections_s,		/* 's' */
   2191  1.1     skrll   special_sections_t,		/* 't' */
   2192  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'u' */
   2193  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'v' */
   2194  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'w' */
   2195  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'x' */
   2196  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'y' */
   2197  1.1     skrll   special_sections_z		/* 'z' */
   2198  1.1     skrll };
   2199  1.1     skrll 
   2200  1.1     skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   2201  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
   2202  1.1     skrll 			      const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
   2203  1.1     skrll 			      unsigned int rela)
   2204  1.1     skrll {
   2205  1.1     skrll   int i;
   2206  1.1     skrll   int len;
   2207  1.1     skrll 
   2208  1.1     skrll   len = strlen (name);
   2209  1.1     skrll 
   2210  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
   2211  1.1     skrll     {
   2212  1.1     skrll       int suffix_len;
   2213  1.1     skrll       int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
   2214  1.1     skrll 
   2215  1.1     skrll       if (len < prefix_len)
   2216  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   2217  1.1     skrll       if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
   2218  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   2219  1.1     skrll 
   2220  1.1     skrll       suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
   2221  1.1     skrll       if (suffix_len <= 0)
   2222  1.1     skrll 	{
   2223  1.1     skrll 	  if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
   2224  1.1     skrll 	    {
   2225  1.1     skrll 	      if (suffix_len == 0)
   2226  1.1     skrll 		continue;
   2227  1.1     skrll 	      if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
   2228  1.1     skrll 		  && (suffix_len == -2
   2229  1.1     skrll 		      || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
   2230  1.1     skrll 		continue;
   2231  1.1     skrll 	    }
   2232  1.1     skrll 	}
   2233  1.1     skrll       else
   2234  1.1     skrll 	{
   2235  1.1     skrll 	  if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
   2236  1.1     skrll 	    continue;
   2237  1.1     skrll 	  if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
   2238  1.1     skrll 		      spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
   2239  1.1     skrll 		      suffix_len) != 0)
   2240  1.1     skrll 	    continue;
   2241  1.1     skrll 	}
   2242  1.1     skrll       return &spec[i];
   2243  1.1     skrll     }
   2244  1.1     skrll 
   2245  1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   2246  1.1     skrll }
   2247  1.1     skrll 
   2248  1.1     skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   2249  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   2250  1.1     skrll {
   2251  1.1     skrll   int i;
   2252  1.1     skrll   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
   2253  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   2254  1.1     skrll 
   2255  1.1     skrll   /* See if this is one of the special sections.  */
   2256  1.1     skrll   if (sec->name == NULL)
   2257  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2258  1.1     skrll 
   2259  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2260  1.1     skrll   spec = bed->special_sections;
   2261  1.1     skrll   if (spec)
   2262  1.1     skrll     {
   2263  1.1     skrll       spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
   2264  1.1     skrll 					   bed->special_sections,
   2265  1.1     skrll 					   sec->use_rela_p);
   2266  1.1     skrll       if (spec != NULL)
   2267  1.1     skrll 	return spec;
   2268  1.1     skrll     }
   2269  1.1     skrll 
   2270  1.1     skrll   if (sec->name[0] != '.')
   2271  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2272  1.1     skrll 
   2273  1.1     skrll   i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
   2274  1.1     skrll   if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
   2275  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2276  1.1     skrll 
   2277  1.1     skrll   spec = special_sections[i];
   2278  1.1     skrll 
   2279  1.1     skrll   if (spec == NULL)
   2280  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2281  1.1     skrll 
   2282  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
   2283  1.1     skrll }
   2284  1.1     skrll 
   2285  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   2286  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   2287  1.1     skrll {
   2288  1.1     skrll   struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
   2289  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   2290  1.1     skrll   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
   2291  1.1     skrll 
   2292  1.1     skrll   sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
   2293  1.3  christos   if (sdata == NULL)
   2294  1.3  christos     {
   2295  1.1     skrll       sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
   2296  1.1     skrll                                                           sizeof (*sdata));
   2297  1.1     skrll       if (sdata == NULL)
   2298  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2299  1.1     skrll       sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
   2300  1.1     skrll     }
   2301  1.1     skrll 
   2302  1.1     skrll   /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations.  */
   2303  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2304  1.1     skrll   sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
   2305  1.1     skrll 
   2306  1.1     skrll   /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
   2307  1.1     skrll      flags.  They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
   2308  1.1     skrll      anyway.  We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
   2309  1.1     skrll      created sections.  If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
   2310  1.1     skrll      set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
   2311  1.1     skrll      elf_fake_sections.  */
   2312  1.1     skrll   if ((!sec->flags && abfd->direction != read_direction)
   2313  1.1     skrll       || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
   2314  1.1     skrll     {
   2315  1.1     skrll       ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
   2316  1.1     skrll       if (ssect != NULL)
   2317  1.1     skrll 	{
   2318  1.1     skrll 	  elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
   2319  1.1     skrll 	  elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
   2320  1.1     skrll 	}
   2321  1.1     skrll     }
   2322  1.1     skrll 
   2323  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
   2324  1.1     skrll }
   2325  1.1     skrll 
   2326  1.1     skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
   2327  1.1     skrll 
   2328  1.1     skrll    Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
   2329  1.1     skrll    of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
   2330  1.1     skrll    program header table.  For segments that are split (see below) we
   2331  1.1     skrll    generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
   2332  1.1     skrll 
   2333  1.1     skrll    Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
   2334  1.1     skrll    (less than) the memory size.  All this means is that at execution the
   2335  1.1     skrll    system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
   2336  1.1     skrll    but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
   2337  1.1     skrll    file.  This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
   2338  1.1     skrll    of combined data+bss.
   2339  1.1     skrll 
   2340  1.1     skrll    To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
   2341  1.1     skrll    for the single program segment.  The first has the length specified by
   2342  1.1     skrll    the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
   2343  1.1     skrll    by the difference between the two sizes.  In effect, the segment is split
   2344  1.1     skrll    into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
   2345  1.1     skrll 
   2346  1.1     skrll  */
   2347  1.1     skrll 
   2348  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   2349  1.3  christos _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
   2350  1.3  christos 				 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
   2351  1.1     skrll 				 int hdr_index,
   2352  1.1     skrll 				 const char *type_name)
   2353  1.1     skrll {
   2354  1.1     skrll   asection *newsect;
   2355  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   2356  1.1     skrll   char namebuf[64];
   2357  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   2358  1.1     skrll   int split;
   2359  1.1     skrll 
   2360  1.1     skrll   split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
   2361  1.1     skrll 	    && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
   2362  1.1     skrll 	    && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
   2363  1.1     skrll 
   2364  1.3  christos   if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
   2365  1.1     skrll     {
   2366  1.3  christos       sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
   2367  1.1     skrll       len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
   2368  1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   2369  1.1     skrll       if (!name)
   2370  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2371  1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
   2372  1.1     skrll       newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
   2373  1.1     skrll       if (newsect == NULL)
   2374  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2375  1.1     skrll       newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
   2376  1.1     skrll       newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
   2377  1.1     skrll       newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
   2378  1.1     skrll       newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
   2379  1.1     skrll       newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
   2380  1.1     skrll       newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
   2381  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   2382  1.1     skrll 	{
   2383  1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
   2384  1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
   2385  1.1     skrll 	  if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
   2386  1.1     skrll 	    {
   2387  1.1     skrll 	      /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
   2388  1.1     skrll 		 may be data.  */
   2389  1.1     skrll 	      newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
   2390  1.1     skrll 	    }
   2391  1.1     skrll 	}
   2392  1.1     skrll       if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
   2393  1.1     skrll 	{
   2394  1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
   2395  1.1     skrll 	}
   2396  1.1     skrll     }
   2397  1.1     skrll 
   2398  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
   2399  1.1     skrll     {
   2400  1.3  christos       bfd_vma align;
   2401  1.1     skrll 
   2402  1.3  christos       sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
   2403  1.1     skrll       len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
   2404  1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   2405  1.1     skrll       if (!name)
   2406  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2407  1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
   2408  1.1     skrll       newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
   2409  1.1     skrll       if (newsect == NULL)
   2410  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2411  1.1     skrll       newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
   2412  1.1     skrll       newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
   2413  1.1     skrll       newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
   2414  1.1     skrll       newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
   2415  1.1     skrll       align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
   2416  1.1     skrll       if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
   2417  1.1     skrll 	align = hdr->p_align;
   2418  1.1     skrll       newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
   2419  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   2420  1.1     skrll 	{
   2421  1.1     skrll 	  /* Hack for gdb.  Segments that have not been modified do
   2422  1.1     skrll 	     not have their contents written to a core file, on the
   2423  1.1     skrll 	     assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
   2424  1.1     skrll 	     executable.  We flag this case by setting the fake
   2425  1.1     skrll 	     section size to zero.  Note that "real" bss sections will
   2426  1.1     skrll 	     always have their contents dumped to the core file.  */
   2427  1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
   2428  1.1     skrll 	    newsect->size = 0;
   2429  1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
   2430  1.1     skrll 	  if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
   2431  1.1     skrll 	    newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
   2432  1.1     skrll 	}
   2433  1.1     skrll       if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
   2434  1.1     skrll 	newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
   2435  1.1     skrll     }
   2436  1.1     skrll 
   2437  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   2438  1.1     skrll }
   2439  1.3  christos 
   2440  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   2441  1.1     skrll bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
   2442  1.1     skrll {
   2443  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   2444  1.1     skrll 
   2445  1.1     skrll   switch (hdr->p_type)
   2446  1.3  christos     {
   2447  1.1     skrll     case PT_NULL:
   2448  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
   2449  1.3  christos 
   2450  1.1     skrll     case PT_LOAD:
   2451  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
   2452  1.3  christos 
   2453  1.1     skrll     case PT_DYNAMIC:
   2454  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
   2455  1.3  christos 
   2456  1.1     skrll     case PT_INTERP:
   2457  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
   2458  1.3  christos 
   2459  1.1     skrll     case PT_NOTE:
   2460  1.1     skrll       if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
   2461  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2462  1.1     skrll       if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz))
   2463  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2464  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   2465  1.3  christos 
   2466  1.1     skrll     case PT_SHLIB:
   2467  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
   2468  1.3  christos 
   2469  1.1     skrll     case PT_PHDR:
   2470  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
   2471  1.3  christos 
   2472  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
   2473  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
   2474  1.1     skrll 					      "eh_frame_hdr");
   2475  1.3  christos 
   2476  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_STACK:
   2477  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
   2478  1.3  christos 
   2479  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_RELRO:
   2480  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
   2481  1.1     skrll 
   2482  1.1     skrll     default:
   2483  1.3  christos       /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types.  */
   2484  1.1     skrll       bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2485  1.1     skrll       return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
   2486  1.1     skrll     }
   2487  1.3  christos }
   2488  1.3  christos 
   2489  1.3  christos /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
   2490  1.3  christos    REL or RELA.  */
   2491  1.3  christos 
   2492  1.3  christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *
   2493  1.3  christos _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
   2494  1.3  christos {
   2495  1.3  christos   if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
   2496  1.3  christos     {
   2497  1.3  christos       BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
   2498  1.3  christos       return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
   2499  1.3  christos     }
   2500  1.3  christos   else
   2501  1.3  christos     return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
   2502  1.3  christos }
   2503  1.3  christos 
   2504  1.3  christos /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
   2505  1.3  christos    containing relocations against ASECT.  It is stored in RELDATA.  If
   2506  1.1     skrll    USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
   2507  1.1     skrll    relocations.  */
   2508  1.1     skrll 
   2509  1.3  christos bfd_boolean
   2510  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
   2511  1.1     skrll 			  struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
   2512  1.1     skrll 			  asection *asect,
   2513  1.3  christos 			  bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
   2514  1.1     skrll {
   2515  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
   2516  1.3  christos   char *name;
   2517  1.3  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2518  1.3  christos   bfd_size_type amt;
   2519  1.3  christos 
   2520  1.3  christos   amt = sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr);
   2521  1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
   2522  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   2523  1.3  christos   reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
   2524  1.3  christos 
   2525  1.1     skrll   amt = sizeof ".rela" + strlen (asect->name);
   2526  1.1     skrll   name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   2527  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   2528  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   2529  1.1     skrll   sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", asect->name);
   2530  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_name =
   2531  1.1     skrll     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
   2532  1.1     skrll 					FALSE);
   2533  1.1     skrll   if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   2534  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   2535  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
   2536  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
   2537  1.1     skrll 			 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
   2538  1.1     skrll 			 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
   2539  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
   2540  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
   2541  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   2542  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
   2543  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
   2544  1.1     skrll 
   2545  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   2546  1.3  christos }
   2547  1.3  christos 
   2548  1.3  christos /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags.  */
   2549  1.3  christos 
   2550  1.3  christos int
   2551  1.3  christos bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
   2552  1.3  christos {
   2553  1.3  christos   if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   2554  1.3  christos       && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
   2555  1.3  christos     return SHT_NOBITS;
   2556  1.3  christos   return SHT_PROGBITS;
   2557  1.3  christos }
   2558  1.3  christos 
   2559  1.3  christos struct fake_section_arg
   2560  1.3  christos {
   2561  1.3  christos   struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
   2562  1.3  christos   bfd_boolean failed;
   2563  1.1     skrll };
   2564  1.1     skrll 
   2565  1.1     skrll /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section.  */
   2566  1.3  christos 
   2567  1.1     skrll static void
   2568  1.3  christos elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
   2569  1.1     skrll {
   2570  1.3  christos   struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
   2571  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2572  1.1     skrll   struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
   2573  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   2574  1.3  christos   unsigned int sh_type;
   2575  1.1     skrll 
   2576  1.1     skrll   if (arg->failed)
   2577  1.1     skrll     {
   2578  1.1     skrll       /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
   2579  1.1     skrll 	 loop.  */
   2580  1.1     skrll       return;
   2581  1.3  christos     }
   2582  1.1     skrll 
   2583  1.1     skrll   this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
   2584  1.1     skrll 
   2585  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   2586  1.1     skrll 							  asect->name, FALSE);
   2587  1.3  christos   if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   2588  1.1     skrll     {
   2589  1.1     skrll       arg->failed = TRUE;
   2590  1.1     skrll       return;
   2591  1.1     skrll     }
   2592  1.1     skrll 
   2593  1.1     skrll   /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits.  */
   2594  1.1     skrll 
   2595  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   2596  1.1     skrll       || asect->user_set_vma)
   2597  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
   2598  1.1     skrll   else
   2599  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   2600  1.1     skrll 
   2601  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
   2602  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
   2603  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
   2604  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
   2605  1.1     skrll   /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
   2606  1.1     skrll      copy_private_section_data.  */
   2607  1.1     skrll 
   2608  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
   2609  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->contents = NULL;
   2610  1.1     skrll 
   2611  1.1     skrll   /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
   2612  1.1     skrll      asect->flags.  */
   2613  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
   2614  1.3  christos     sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
   2615  1.1     skrll   else
   2616  1.1     skrll     sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
   2617  1.1     skrll 
   2618  1.1     skrll   if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
   2619  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
   2620  1.1     skrll   else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   2621  1.1     skrll 	   && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
   2622  1.1     skrll 	   && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   2623  1.1     skrll     {
   2624  1.1     skrll       /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
   2625  1.1     skrll 	 allow the link to proceed.  This can happen when users link
   2626  1.1     skrll 	 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
   2627  1.1     skrll 	 to a bss output section via a linker script.  */
   2628  1.1     skrll       (*_bfd_error_handler)
   2629  1.1     skrll 	(_("warning: section `%A' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
   2630  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
   2631  1.1     skrll     }
   2632  1.1     skrll 
   2633  1.1     skrll   switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
   2634  1.1     skrll     {
   2635  1.1     skrll     default:
   2636  1.1     skrll       break;
   2637  1.1     skrll 
   2638  1.1     skrll     case SHT_STRTAB:
   2639  1.1     skrll     case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
   2640  1.1     skrll     case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
   2641  1.1     skrll     case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
   2642  1.1     skrll     case SHT_NOTE:
   2643  1.1     skrll     case SHT_NOBITS:
   2644  1.1     skrll     case SHT_PROGBITS:
   2645  1.1     skrll       break;
   2646  1.1     skrll 
   2647  1.1     skrll     case SHT_HASH:
   2648  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
   2649  1.1     skrll       break;
   2650  1.1     skrll 
   2651  1.1     skrll     case SHT_DYNSYM:
   2652  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
   2653  1.1     skrll       break;
   2654  1.1     skrll 
   2655  1.1     skrll     case SHT_DYNAMIC:
   2656  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
   2657  1.1     skrll       break;
   2658  1.1     skrll 
   2659  1.1     skrll     case SHT_RELA:
   2660  1.1     skrll       if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
   2661  1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
   2662  1.1     skrll       break;
   2663  1.1     skrll 
   2664  1.1     skrll      case SHT_REL:
   2665  1.1     skrll       if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
   2666  1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
   2667  1.1     skrll       break;
   2668  1.1     skrll 
   2669  1.1     skrll      case SHT_GNU_versym:
   2670  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
   2671  1.1     skrll       break;
   2672  1.1     skrll 
   2673  1.1     skrll      case SHT_GNU_verdef:
   2674  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   2675  1.1     skrll       /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
   2676  1.1     skrll 	 cverdefs.  The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
   2677  1.1     skrll 	 zero.  */
   2678  1.1     skrll       if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
   2679  1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
   2680  1.1     skrll       else
   2681  1.1     skrll 	BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
   2682  1.1     skrll 		    || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
   2683  1.1     skrll       break;
   2684  1.1     skrll 
   2685  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_verneed:
   2686  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   2687  1.1     skrll       /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
   2688  1.1     skrll 	 cverrefs.  The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
   2689  1.1     skrll 	 zero.  */
   2690  1.1     skrll       if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
   2691  1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
   2692  1.1     skrll       else
   2693  1.1     skrll 	BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
   2694  1.1     skrll 		    || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
   2695  1.1     skrll       break;
   2696  1.1     skrll 
   2697  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GROUP:
   2698  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
   2699  1.1     skrll       break;
   2700  1.1     skrll 
   2701  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_HASH:
   2702  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
   2703  1.1     skrll       break;
   2704  1.1     skrll     }
   2705  1.1     skrll 
   2706  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   2707  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
   2708  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   2709  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
   2710  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   2711  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
   2712  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
   2713  1.1     skrll     {
   2714  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
   2715  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
   2716  1.1     skrll       if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
   2717  1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
   2718  1.1     skrll     }
   2719  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
   2720  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
   2721  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   2722  1.1     skrll     {
   2723  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
   2724  1.1     skrll       if (asect->size == 0
   2725  1.1     skrll 	  && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
   2726  1.1     skrll 	{
   2727  1.1     skrll 	  struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
   2728  1.1     skrll 
   2729  1.1     skrll 	  this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
   2730  1.1     skrll 	  if (o != NULL)
   2731  1.1     skrll 	    {
   2732  1.1     skrll 	      this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
   2733  1.1     skrll 	      if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
   2734  1.1     skrll 		this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
   2735  1.1     skrll 	    }
   2736  1.3  christos 	}
   2737  1.3  christos     }
   2738  1.3  christos   if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
   2739  1.3  christos     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
   2740  1.3  christos 
   2741  1.3  christos   /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
   2742  1.3  christos      SHT_REL[A] section.  If two relocation sections are required for
   2743  1.3  christos      this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
   2744  1.3  christos      create the other.  */
   2745  1.3  christos   if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
   2746  1.3  christos     {
   2747  1.3  christos       /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
   2748  1.3  christos 	 needed.  */
   2749  1.3  christos       if (arg->link_info
   2750  1.3  christos 	  /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here.  */
   2751  1.3  christos 	  && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
   2752  1.3  christos 	  && (arg->link_info->relocatable || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
   2753  1.3  christos 	{
   2754  1.3  christos 	  if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
   2755  1.3  christos 	      && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, asect, FALSE))
   2756  1.3  christos 	    {
   2757  1.3  christos 	      arg->failed = TRUE;
   2758  1.3  christos 	      return;
   2759  1.3  christos 	    }
   2760  1.3  christos 	  if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
   2761  1.3  christos 	      && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, asect, TRUE))
   2762  1.3  christos 	    {
   2763  1.3  christos 	      arg->failed = TRUE;
   2764  1.3  christos 	      return;
   2765  1.3  christos 	    }
   2766  1.3  christos 	}
   2767  1.3  christos       else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
   2768  1.3  christos 					  (asect->use_rela_p
   2769  1.3  christos 					   ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
   2770  1.3  christos 					  asect,
   2771  1.3  christos 					  asect->use_rela_p))
   2772  1.1     skrll 	  arg->failed = TRUE;
   2773  1.1     skrll     }
   2774  1.1     skrll 
   2775  1.1     skrll   /* Check for processor-specific section types.  */
   2776  1.1     skrll   sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
   2777  1.3  christos   if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
   2778  1.1     skrll       && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
   2779  1.1     skrll     arg->failed = TRUE;
   2780  1.1     skrll 
   2781  1.1     skrll   if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
   2782  1.1     skrll     {
   2783  1.1     skrll       /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
   2784  1.1     skrll 	 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug.  */
   2785  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
   2786  1.1     skrll     }
   2787  1.2     skrll }
   2788  1.2     skrll 
   2789  1.2     skrll /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section.  Called from
   2790  1.2     skrll    _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
   2791  1.1     skrll    when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld.  Called for ld -r
   2792  1.1     skrll    from bfd_elf_final_link.  */
   2793  1.1     skrll 
   2794  1.1     skrll void
   2795  1.3  christos bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
   2796  1.1     skrll {
   2797  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
   2798  1.1     skrll   asection *elt, *first;
   2799  1.1     skrll   unsigned char *loc;
   2800  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean gas;
   2801  1.1     skrll 
   2802  1.1     skrll   /* Ignore linker created group section.  See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
   2803  1.1     skrll      elfxx-ia64.c.  */
   2804  1.1     skrll   if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
   2805  1.1     skrll       || *failedptr)
   2806  1.2     skrll     return;
   2807  1.2     skrll 
   2808  1.2     skrll   if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
   2809  1.2     skrll     {
   2810  1.2     skrll       unsigned long symindx = 0;
   2811  1.2     skrll 
   2812  1.2     skrll       /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
   2813  1.2     skrll 	 generic linker.  */
   2814  1.2     skrll       if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
   2815  1.2     skrll 	symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
   2816  1.2     skrll 
   2817  1.2     skrll       if (symindx == 0)
   2818  1.2     skrll 	{
   2819  1.2     skrll 	  /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
   2820  1.2     skrll 	     elf_section_syms.  */
   2821  1.2     skrll 	  BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
   2822  1.2     skrll 	  symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
   2823  1.2     skrll 	}
   2824  1.2     skrll       elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
   2825  1.2     skrll     }
   2826  1.2     skrll   else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
   2827  1.2     skrll     {
   2828  1.2     skrll       /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
   2829  1.2     skrll 	 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
   2830  1.2     skrll 	 set until all local symbols are output.  */
   2831  1.2     skrll       asection *igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
   2832  1.2     skrll       struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
   2833  1.2     skrll       unsigned long symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
   2834  1.2     skrll       unsigned long extsymoff = 0;
   2835  1.2     skrll       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   2836  1.2     skrll 
   2837  1.2     skrll       if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
   2838  1.2     skrll 	{
   2839  1.2     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   2840  1.2     skrll 
   2841  1.2     skrll 	  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
   2842  1.2     skrll 	  extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   2843  1.2     skrll 	}
   2844  1.2     skrll       h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
   2845  1.2     skrll       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   2846  1.2     skrll 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   2847  1.2     skrll 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   2848  1.1     skrll 
   2849  1.1     skrll       elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
   2850  1.1     skrll     }
   2851  1.1     skrll 
   2852  1.1     skrll   /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy.  */
   2853  1.1     skrll   gas = TRUE;
   2854  1.1     skrll   if (sec->contents == NULL)
   2855  1.3  christos     {
   2856  1.1     skrll       gas = FALSE;
   2857  1.1     skrll       sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
   2858  1.1     skrll 
   2859  1.1     skrll       /* Arrange for the section to be written out.  */
   2860  1.1     skrll       elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
   2861  1.1     skrll       if (sec->contents == NULL)
   2862  1.1     skrll 	{
   2863  1.1     skrll 	  *failedptr = TRUE;
   2864  1.1     skrll 	  return;
   2865  1.1     skrll 	}
   2866  1.1     skrll     }
   2867  1.1     skrll 
   2868  1.1     skrll   loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
   2869  1.1     skrll 
   2870  1.1     skrll   /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
   2871  1.1     skrll      squirreled away here.  objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
   2872  1.1     skrll      start of the input section group.  */
   2873  1.1     skrll   first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
   2874  1.1     skrll 
   2875  1.1     skrll   /* First element is a flag word.  Rest of section is elf section
   2876  1.1     skrll      indices for all the sections of the group.  Write them backwards
   2877  1.1     skrll      just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
   2878  1.1     skrll      directives, not that it matters.  */
   2879  1.1     skrll   while (elt != NULL)
   2880  1.1     skrll     {
   2881  1.1     skrll       asection *s;
   2882  1.1     skrll 
   2883  1.1     skrll       s = elt;
   2884  1.3  christos       if (!gas)
   2885  1.3  christos 	s = s->output_section;
   2886  1.3  christos       if (s != NULL
   2887  1.3  christos 	  && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
   2888  1.3  christos 	{
   2889  1.3  christos 	  unsigned int idx = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   2890  1.3  christos 
   2891  1.3  christos 	  loc -= 4;
   2892  1.1     skrll 	  H_PUT_32 (abfd, idx, loc);
   2893  1.1     skrll 	}
   2894  1.1     skrll       elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
   2895  1.1     skrll       if (elt == first)
   2896  1.1     skrll 	break;
   2897  1.1     skrll     }
   2898  1.1     skrll 
   2899  1.1     skrll   if ((loc -= 4) != sec->contents)
   2900  1.1     skrll     abort ();
   2901  1.1     skrll 
   2902  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
   2903  1.1     skrll }
   2904  1.1     skrll 
   2905  1.1     skrll /* Assign all ELF section numbers.  The dummy first section is handled here
   2906  1.1     skrll    too.  The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
   2907  1.1     skrll    in here too, while we're at it.  */
   2908  1.1     skrll 
   2909  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   2910  1.1     skrll assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   2911  1.1     skrll {
   2912  1.1     skrll   struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
   2913  1.1     skrll   asection *sec;
   2914  1.1     skrll   unsigned int section_number, secn;
   2915  1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
   2916  1.1     skrll   struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
   2917  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean need_symtab;
   2918  1.1     skrll 
   2919  1.1     skrll   section_number = 1;
   2920  1.1     skrll 
   2921  1.1     skrll   _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   2922  1.1     skrll 
   2923  1.1     skrll   /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only.  */
   2924  1.1     skrll   if (link_info == NULL || link_info->relocatable)
   2925  1.1     skrll     {
   2926  1.1     skrll       /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first.  */
   2927  1.1     skrll       for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   2928  1.1     skrll 	{
   2929  1.1     skrll 	  d = elf_section_data (sec);
   2930  1.1     skrll 
   2931  1.1     skrll 	  if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
   2932  1.1     skrll 	    {
   2933  1.1     skrll 	      if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
   2934  1.1     skrll 		{
   2935  1.1     skrll 		  /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections.  */
   2936  1.1     skrll 		  bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
   2937  1.1     skrll 		  abfd->section_count--;
   2938  1.1     skrll 		}
   2939  1.1     skrll 	      else
   2940  1.1     skrll 		d->this_idx = section_number++;
   2941  1.1     skrll 	    }
   2942  1.1     skrll 	}
   2943  1.1     skrll     }
   2944  1.1     skrll 
   2945  1.1     skrll   for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
   2946  1.1     skrll     {
   2947  1.1     skrll       d = elf_section_data (sec);
   2948  1.1     skrll 
   2949  1.1     skrll       if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
   2950  1.3  christos 	d->this_idx = section_number++;
   2951  1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
   2952  1.3  christos       if (d->rel.hdr)
   2953  1.3  christos 	{
   2954  1.1     skrll 	  d->rel.idx = section_number++;
   2955  1.3  christos 	  _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
   2956  1.3  christos 	}
   2957  1.1     skrll       else
   2958  1.3  christos 	d->rel.idx = 0;
   2959  1.1     skrll 
   2960  1.3  christos       if (d->rela.hdr)
   2961  1.3  christos 	{
   2962  1.1     skrll 	  d->rela.idx = section_number++;
   2963  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
   2964  1.3  christos 	}
   2965  1.1     skrll       else
   2966  1.1     skrll 	d->rela.idx = 0;
   2967  1.1     skrll     }
   2968  1.1     skrll 
   2969  1.1     skrll   t->shstrtab_section = section_number++;
   2970  1.1     skrll   _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
   2971  1.3  christos   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = t->shstrtab_section;
   2972  1.3  christos 
   2973  1.3  christos   need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
   2974  1.3  christos 		|| (link_info == NULL
   2975  1.3  christos 		    && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
   2976  1.1     skrll 			== HAS_RELOC)));
   2977  1.1     skrll   if (need_symtab)
   2978  1.1     skrll     {
   2979  1.1     skrll       t->symtab_section = section_number++;
   2980  1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
   2981  1.1     skrll       if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
   2982  1.1     skrll 	{
   2983  1.1     skrll 	  t->symtab_shndx_section = section_number++;
   2984  1.1     skrll 	  t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name
   2985  1.1     skrll 	    = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   2986  1.1     skrll 						  ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
   2987  1.1     skrll 	  if (t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   2988  1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
   2989  1.1     skrll 	}
   2990  1.1     skrll       t->strtab_section = section_number++;
   2991  1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
   2992  1.1     skrll     }
   2993  1.1     skrll 
   2994  1.1     skrll   _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   2995  1.1     skrll   t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   2996  1.1     skrll 
   2997  1.1     skrll   elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
   2998  1.1     skrll   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
   2999  1.1     skrll 
   3000  1.3  christos   /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
   3001  1.3  christos      indices.  */
   3002  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
   3003  1.1     skrll                                                 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
   3004  1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp == NULL)
   3005  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   3006  1.3  christos 
   3007  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
   3008  1.1     skrll                                                  sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
   3009  1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
   3010  1.1     skrll     {
   3011  1.1     skrll       bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
   3012  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   3013  1.1     skrll     }
   3014  1.1     skrll 
   3015  1.1     skrll   elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
   3016  1.3  christos 
   3017  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp[t->shstrtab_section] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
   3018  1.1     skrll   if (need_symtab)
   3019  1.1     skrll     {
   3020  1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[t->symtab_section] = &t->symtab_hdr;
   3021  1.1     skrll       if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
   3022  1.1     skrll 	{
   3023  1.1     skrll 	  i_shdrp[t->symtab_shndx_section] = &t->symtab_shndx_hdr;
   3024  1.1     skrll 	  t->symtab_shndx_hdr.sh_link = t->symtab_section;
   3025  1.1     skrll 	}
   3026  1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[t->strtab_section] = &t->strtab_hdr;
   3027  1.1     skrll       t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = t->strtab_section;
   3028  1.1     skrll     }
   3029  1.1     skrll 
   3030  1.1     skrll   for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
   3031  1.1     skrll     {
   3032  1.1     skrll       asection *s;
   3033  1.3  christos       const char *name;
   3034  1.3  christos 
   3035  1.1     skrll       d = elf_section_data (sec);
   3036  1.3  christos 
   3037  1.3  christos       i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
   3038  1.3  christos       if (d->rel.idx != 0)
   3039  1.3  christos 	i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
   3040  1.1     skrll       if (d->rela.idx != 0)
   3041  1.1     skrll 	i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
   3042  1.1     skrll 
   3043  1.1     skrll       /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it.  */
   3044  1.1     skrll 
   3045  1.1     skrll       /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
   3046  1.3  christos 	 table.  sh_info is the section index of the section to which
   3047  1.1     skrll 	 the relocation entries apply.  */
   3048  1.3  christos       if (d->rel.idx != 0)
   3049  1.3  christos 	{
   3050  1.1     skrll 	  d->rel.hdr->sh_link = t->symtab_section;
   3051  1.3  christos 	  d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
   3052  1.1     skrll 	}
   3053  1.3  christos       if (d->rela.idx != 0)
   3054  1.3  christos 	{
   3055  1.1     skrll 	  d->rela.hdr->sh_link = t->symtab_section;
   3056  1.1     skrll 	  d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
   3057  1.1     skrll 	}
   3058  1.1     skrll 
   3059  1.1     skrll       /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER.  */
   3060  1.1     skrll       if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
   3061  1.1     skrll 	{
   3062  1.1     skrll 	  s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
   3063  1.1     skrll 	  if (s)
   3064  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3065  1.1     skrll 	      /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section.  */
   3066  1.1     skrll 	      if (link_info != NULL)
   3067  1.1     skrll 		{
   3068  1.1     skrll 		  /* Check discarded linkonce section.  */
   3069  1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_discarded_section (s))
   3070  1.1     skrll 		    {
   3071  1.1     skrll 		      asection *kept;
   3072  1.1     skrll 		      (*_bfd_error_handler)
   3073  1.1     skrll 			(_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
   3074  1.1     skrll 			 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
   3075  1.1     skrll 			 s, s->owner);
   3076  1.1     skrll 		      /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
   3077  1.1     skrll 			 size as the discarded one.  */
   3078  1.1     skrll 		      kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
   3079  1.1     skrll 		      if (kept == NULL)
   3080  1.1     skrll 			{
   3081  1.1     skrll 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3082  1.1     skrll 			  return FALSE;
   3083  1.1     skrll 			}
   3084  1.1     skrll 		      s = kept;
   3085  1.1     skrll 		    }
   3086  1.1     skrll 
   3087  1.1     skrll 		  s = s->output_section;
   3088  1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   3089  1.1     skrll 		}
   3090  1.1     skrll 	      else
   3091  1.1     skrll 		{
   3092  1.1     skrll 		  /* Handle objcopy. */
   3093  1.1     skrll 		  if (s->output_section == NULL)
   3094  1.1     skrll 		    {
   3095  1.1     skrll 		      (*_bfd_error_handler)
   3096  1.1     skrll 			(_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
   3097  1.1     skrll 			 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
   3098  1.1     skrll 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3099  1.1     skrll 		      return FALSE;
   3100  1.1     skrll 		    }
   3101  1.1     skrll 		  s = s->output_section;
   3102  1.1     skrll 		}
   3103  1.1     skrll 	      d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3104  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3105  1.1     skrll 	  else
   3106  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3107  1.1     skrll 	      /* PR 290:
   3108  1.1     skrll 		 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
   3109  1.1     skrll 		 SHF_LINK_ORDER.  But it doesn't set the sh_link or
   3110  1.1     skrll 		 sh_info fields.  Hence we could get the situation
   3111  1.1     skrll 		 where s is NULL.  */
   3112  1.1     skrll 	      const struct elf_backend_data *bed
   3113  1.1     skrll 		= get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3114  1.1     skrll 	      if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
   3115  1.1     skrll 		bed->link_order_error_handler
   3116  1.1     skrll 		  (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
   3117  1.1     skrll 		   abfd, sec);
   3118  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3119  1.1     skrll 	}
   3120  1.1     skrll 
   3121  1.1     skrll       switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
   3122  1.1     skrll 	{
   3123  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_REL:
   3124  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_RELA:
   3125  1.1     skrll 	  /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
   3126  1.1     skrll 	     section.  sh_link is the section index of the symbol
   3127  1.1     skrll 	     table.  sh_info is the section index of the section to
   3128  1.1     skrll 	     which the relocation entries apply.  We assume that an
   3129  1.1     skrll 	     allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
   3130  1.1     skrll 	     FIXME: How can we be sure?  */
   3131  1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
   3132  1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3133  1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3134  1.1     skrll 
   3135  1.1     skrll 	  /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name.  */
   3136  1.1     skrll 	  name = sec->name;
   3137  1.1     skrll 	  if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL)
   3138  1.1     skrll 	    name += 4;
   3139  1.1     skrll 	  else
   3140  1.1     skrll 	    name += 5;
   3141  1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
   3142  1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3143  1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3144  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3145  1.1     skrll 
   3146  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_STRTAB:
   3147  1.1     skrll 	  /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
   3148  1.1     skrll 	     string section.  We look for a section with the same name
   3149  1.1     skrll 	     but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
   3150  1.1     skrll 	     field to point to this section.  */
   3151  1.1     skrll 	  if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
   3152  1.1     skrll 	      && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
   3153  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3154  1.1     skrll 	      size_t len;
   3155  1.1     skrll 	      char *alc;
   3156  1.3  christos 
   3157  1.1     skrll 	      len = strlen (sec->name);
   3158  1.1     skrll 	      alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
   3159  1.1     skrll 	      if (alc == NULL)
   3160  1.1     skrll 		return FALSE;
   3161  1.1     skrll 	      memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
   3162  1.1     skrll 	      alc[len - 3] = '\0';
   3163  1.1     skrll 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
   3164  1.1     skrll 	      free (alc);
   3165  1.1     skrll 	      if (s != NULL)
   3166  1.1     skrll 		{
   3167  1.1     skrll 		  elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
   3168  1.1     skrll 
   3169  1.1     skrll 		  /* This is a .stab section.  */
   3170  1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
   3171  1.1     skrll 		    elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
   3172  1.1     skrll 		      = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
   3173  1.1     skrll 		}
   3174  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3175  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3176  1.1     skrll 
   3177  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_DYNAMIC:
   3178  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_DYNSYM:
   3179  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_verneed:
   3180  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_verdef:
   3181  1.1     skrll 	  /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
   3182  1.1     skrll 	     used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
   3183  1.1     skrll 	     version strings.  */
   3184  1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
   3185  1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3186  1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3187  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3188  1.1     skrll 
   3189  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
   3190  1.1     skrll 	  /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
   3191  1.1     skrll 	     list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
   3192  1.1     skrll 	     the version strings.  */
   3193  1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
   3194  1.1     skrll 					     ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
   3195  1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3196  1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3197  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3198  1.1     skrll 
   3199  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_HASH:
   3200  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_HASH:
   3201  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_versym:
   3202  1.1     skrll 	  /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
   3203  1.1     skrll 	     this hash table or version table is for.  */
   3204  1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
   3205  1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3206  1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3207  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3208  1.1     skrll 
   3209  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GROUP:
   3210  1.1     skrll 	  d->this_hdr.sh_link = t->symtab_section;
   3211  1.1     skrll 	}
   3212  1.1     skrll     }
   3213  1.1     skrll 
   3214  1.1     skrll   for (secn = 1; secn < section_number; ++secn)
   3215  1.1     skrll     if (i_shdrp[secn] == NULL)
   3216  1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[secn] = i_shdrp[0];
   3217  1.1     skrll     else
   3218  1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[secn]->sh_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   3219  1.1     skrll 						       i_shdrp[secn]->sh_name);
   3220  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   3221  1.1     skrll }
   3222  1.1     skrll 
   3223  1.1     skrll /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
   3224  1.1     skrll    all local symbols to be at the head of the list.  */
   3225  1.1     skrll 
   3226  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   3227  1.1     skrll sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
   3228  1.1     skrll {
   3229  1.1     skrll   /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it.  */
   3230  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3231  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
   3232  1.3  christos     return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
   3233  1.1     skrll 
   3234  1.1     skrll   return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
   3235  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
   3236  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
   3237  1.1     skrll }
   3238  1.1     skrll 
   3239  1.1     skrll /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
   3240  1.1     skrll    output.  */
   3241  1.1     skrll 
   3242  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   3243  1.1     skrll ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
   3244  1.1     skrll {
   3245  1.1     skrll   return ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
   3246  1.1     skrll 	  && !(sym->section->owner == abfd
   3247  1.1     skrll 	       || (sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
   3248  1.1     skrll 		   && sym->section->output_offset == 0)));
   3249  1.1     skrll }
   3250  1.1     skrll 
   3251  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   3252  1.1     skrll elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd)
   3253  1.1     skrll {
   3254  1.1     skrll   unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
   3255  1.1     skrll   asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
   3256  1.1     skrll   asymbol **sect_syms;
   3257  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_locals = 0;
   3258  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_globals = 0;
   3259  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
   3260  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
   3261  1.1     skrll   int max_index = 0;
   3262  1.1     skrll   unsigned int idx;
   3263  1.1     skrll   asection *asect;
   3264  1.1     skrll   asymbol **new_syms;
   3265  1.1     skrll 
   3266  1.1     skrll #ifdef DEBUG
   3267  1.1     skrll   fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
   3268  1.1     skrll   fflush (stderr);
   3269  1.1     skrll #endif
   3270  1.1     skrll 
   3271  1.1     skrll   for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
   3272  1.1     skrll     {
   3273  1.1     skrll       if (max_index < asect->index)
   3274  1.1     skrll 	max_index = asect->index;
   3275  1.1     skrll     }
   3276  1.3  christos 
   3277  1.1     skrll   max_index++;
   3278  1.1     skrll   sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
   3279  1.1     skrll   if (sect_syms == NULL)
   3280  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3281  1.1     skrll   elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
   3282  1.1     skrll   elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
   3283  1.1     skrll 
   3284  1.1     skrll   /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
   3285  1.1     skrll      decided to output.  */
   3286  1.1     skrll   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
   3287  1.1     skrll     {
   3288  1.1     skrll       asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
   3289  1.1     skrll 
   3290  1.1     skrll       if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
   3291  1.1     skrll 	  && sym->value == 0
   3292  1.1     skrll 	  && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
   3293  1.1     skrll 	{
   3294  1.1     skrll 	  asection *sec = sym->section;
   3295  1.1     skrll 
   3296  1.1     skrll 	  if (sec->owner != abfd)
   3297  1.1     skrll 	    sec = sec->output_section;
   3298  1.1     skrll 
   3299  1.1     skrll 	  sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
   3300  1.1     skrll 	}
   3301  1.1     skrll     }
   3302  1.1     skrll 
   3303  1.1     skrll   /* Classify all of the symbols.  */
   3304  1.1     skrll   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
   3305  1.1     skrll     {
   3306  1.1     skrll       if (ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
   3307  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   3308  1.1     skrll       if (!sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
   3309  1.1     skrll 	num_locals++;
   3310  1.1     skrll       else
   3311  1.1     skrll 	num_globals++;
   3312  1.1     skrll     }
   3313  1.1     skrll 
   3314  1.1     skrll   /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section.  Most
   3315  1.1     skrll      sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
   3316  1.1     skrll      eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
   3317  1.1     skrll      at least in that case.  */
   3318  1.1     skrll   for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
   3319  1.1     skrll     {
   3320  1.1     skrll       if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
   3321  1.1     skrll 	{
   3322  1.1     skrll 	  if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
   3323  1.1     skrll 	    num_locals++;
   3324  1.1     skrll 	  else
   3325  1.1     skrll 	    num_globals++;
   3326  1.1     skrll 	}
   3327  1.1     skrll     }
   3328  1.3  christos 
   3329  1.3  christos   /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first.  */
   3330  1.1     skrll   new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
   3331  1.1     skrll                                       sizeof (asymbol *));
   3332  1.1     skrll 
   3333  1.1     skrll   if (new_syms == NULL)
   3334  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3335  1.1     skrll 
   3336  1.1     skrll   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
   3337  1.1     skrll     {
   3338  1.1     skrll       asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
   3339  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   3340  1.1     skrll 
   3341  1.1     skrll       if (ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
   3342  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   3343  1.1     skrll       if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
   3344  1.1     skrll 	i = num_locals2++;
   3345  1.1     skrll       else
   3346  1.1     skrll 	i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
   3347  1.1     skrll       new_syms[i] = sym;
   3348  1.1     skrll       sym->udata.i = i + 1;
   3349  1.1     skrll     }
   3350  1.1     skrll   for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
   3351  1.1     skrll     {
   3352  1.1     skrll       if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
   3353  1.1     skrll 	{
   3354  1.1     skrll 	  asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
   3355  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int i;
   3356  1.1     skrll 
   3357  1.1     skrll 	  sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
   3358  1.1     skrll 	  if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
   3359  1.1     skrll 	    i = num_locals2++;
   3360  1.1     skrll 	  else
   3361  1.1     skrll 	    i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
   3362  1.1     skrll 	  new_syms[i] = sym;
   3363  1.1     skrll 	  sym->udata.i = i + 1;
   3364  1.1     skrll 	}
   3365  1.1     skrll     }
   3366  1.1     skrll 
   3367  1.1     skrll   bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
   3368  1.1     skrll 
   3369  1.1     skrll   elf_num_locals (abfd) = num_locals;
   3370  1.1     skrll   elf_num_globals (abfd) = num_globals;
   3371  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   3372  1.1     skrll }
   3373  1.1     skrll 
   3374  1.1     skrll /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
   3375  1.1     skrll    ELF data structure.  */
   3376  1.1     skrll 
   3377  1.1     skrll static inline file_ptr
   3378  1.1     skrll align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
   3379  1.1     skrll {
   3380  1.1     skrll   return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
   3381  1.1     skrll }
   3382  1.1     skrll 
   3383  1.1     skrll /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
   3384  1.1     skrll    required section alignment.  */
   3385  1.1     skrll 
   3386  1.1     skrll file_ptr
   3387  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
   3388  1.1     skrll 					   file_ptr offset,
   3389  1.1     skrll 					   bfd_boolean align)
   3390  1.1     skrll {
   3391  1.1     skrll   if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
   3392  1.1     skrll     offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
   3393  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
   3394  1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
   3395  1.1     skrll     i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
   3396  1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   3397  1.1     skrll     offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
   3398  1.1     skrll   return offset;
   3399  1.1     skrll }
   3400  1.1     skrll 
   3401  1.1     skrll /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
   3402  1.1     skrll    otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file.  If LINK_INFO
   3403  1.1     skrll    is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker.  */
   3404  1.1     skrll 
   3405  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   3406  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
   3407  1.1     skrll 					 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   3408  1.3  christos {
   3409  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3410  1.1     skrll   struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
   3411  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean failed;
   3412  1.3  christos   struct bfd_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
   3413  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
   3414  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean need_symtab;
   3415  1.1     skrll 
   3416  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->output_has_begun)
   3417  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   3418  1.1     skrll 
   3419  1.1     skrll   /* Do any elf backend specific processing first.  */
   3420  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
   3421  1.1     skrll     (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
   3422  1.1     skrll 
   3423  1.1     skrll   if (! prep_headers (abfd))
   3424  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3425  1.1     skrll 
   3426  1.1     skrll   /* Post process the headers if necessary.  */
   3427  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers)
   3428  1.3  christos     (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
   3429  1.3  christos 
   3430  1.3  christos   fsargs.failed = FALSE;
   3431  1.3  christos   fsargs.link_info = link_info;
   3432  1.1     skrll   bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
   3433  1.1     skrll   if (fsargs.failed)
   3434  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3435  1.1     skrll 
   3436  1.1     skrll   if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
   3437  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3438  1.3  christos 
   3439  1.3  christos   /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself.  */
   3440  1.3  christos   need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
   3441  1.3  christos 		 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
   3442  1.3  christos 		     || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
   3443  1.1     skrll 			 == HAS_RELOC)));
   3444  1.1     skrll   if (need_symtab)
   3445  1.1     skrll     {
   3446  1.1     skrll       /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link.  */
   3447  1.1     skrll       int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
   3448  1.1     skrll 
   3449  1.1     skrll       if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
   3450  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   3451  1.3  christos     }
   3452  1.1     skrll 
   3453  1.1     skrll   failed = FALSE;
   3454  1.1     skrll   if (link_info == NULL)
   3455  1.1     skrll     {
   3456  1.1     skrll       bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
   3457  1.1     skrll       if (failed)
   3458  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   3459  1.1     skrll     }
   3460  1.1     skrll 
   3461  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
   3462  1.1     skrll   /* sh_name was set in prep_headers.  */
   3463  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
   3464  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
   3465  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   3466  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   3467  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   3468  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
   3469  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
   3470  1.1     skrll   /* sh_offset is set in assign_file_positions_except_relocs.  */
   3471  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
   3472  1.1     skrll 
   3473  1.1     skrll   if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
   3474  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   3475  1.1     skrll 
   3476  1.1     skrll   if (need_symtab)
   3477  1.1     skrll     {
   3478  1.1     skrll       file_ptr off;
   3479  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   3480  1.1     skrll 
   3481  1.1     skrll       off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
   3482  1.1     skrll 
   3483  1.1     skrll       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   3484  1.1     skrll       off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   3485  1.1     skrll 
   3486  1.1     skrll       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
   3487  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   3488  1.1     skrll 	off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   3489  1.1     skrll 
   3490  1.1     skrll       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
   3491  1.1     skrll       off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   3492  1.1     skrll 
   3493  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
   3494  1.1     skrll 
   3495  1.1     skrll       /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
   3496  1.1     skrll 	 out.  */
   3497  1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   3498  1.1     skrll 	  || ! _bfd_stringtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
   3499  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   3500  1.1     skrll       _bfd_stringtab_free (strtab);
   3501  1.1     skrll     }
   3502  1.1     skrll 
   3503  1.1     skrll   abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
   3504  1.1     skrll 
   3505  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   3506  1.1     skrll }
   3507  1.1     skrll 
   3508  1.1     skrll /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header.  If we
   3509  1.1     skrll    get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement.  */
   3510  1.1     skrll 
   3511  1.1     skrll static bfd_size_type
   3512  1.1     skrll get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3513  1.1     skrll {
   3514  1.1     skrll   size_t segs;
   3515  1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   3516  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   3517  1.1     skrll 
   3518  1.1     skrll   /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
   3519  1.1     skrll      and one for data.  */
   3520  1.1     skrll   segs = 2;
   3521  1.1     skrll 
   3522  1.1     skrll   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
   3523  1.1     skrll   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   3524  1.1     skrll     {
   3525  1.1     skrll       /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
   3526  1.1     skrll 	 PT_INTERP segment.  In this case, assume we also need a
   3527  1.1     skrll 	 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
   3528  1.1     skrll 	 targets.  */
   3529  1.1     skrll       segs += 2;
   3530  1.1     skrll     }
   3531  1.1     skrll 
   3532  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
   3533  1.1     skrll     {
   3534  1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
   3535  1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   3536  1.1     skrll     }
   3537  1.1     skrll 
   3538  1.1     skrll   if (info != NULL && info->relro)
   3539  1.1     skrll     {
   3540  1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  */
   3541  1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   3542  1.1     skrll     }
   3543  1.1     skrll 
   3544  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->eh_frame_hdr)
   3545  1.1     skrll     {
   3546  1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment.  */
   3547  1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   3548  1.1     skrll     }
   3549  1.1     skrll 
   3550  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags)
   3551  1.1     skrll     {
   3552  1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment.  */
   3553  1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   3554  1.1     skrll     }
   3555  1.1     skrll 
   3556  1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   3557  1.1     skrll     {
   3558  1.1     skrll       if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   3559  1.1     skrll 	  && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
   3560  1.1     skrll 	{
   3561  1.1     skrll 	  /* We need a PT_NOTE segment.  */
   3562  1.1     skrll 	  ++segs;
   3563  1.1     skrll 	  /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
   3564  1.1     skrll 	     for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
   3565  1.1     skrll 	     gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
   3566  1.1     skrll 	     (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
   3567  1.1     skrll 	     each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
   3568  1.1     skrll 	     so we check whether the sections are correctly
   3569  1.1     skrll 	     aligned.  */
   3570  1.1     skrll 	  if (s->alignment_power == 2)
   3571  1.1     skrll 	    while (s->next != NULL
   3572  1.1     skrll 		   && s->next->alignment_power == 2
   3573  1.1     skrll 		   && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   3574  1.1     skrll 		   && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
   3575  1.1     skrll 	      s = s->next;
   3576  1.1     skrll 	}
   3577  1.1     skrll     }
   3578  1.1     skrll 
   3579  1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   3580  1.1     skrll     {
   3581  1.1     skrll       if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   3582  1.1     skrll 	{
   3583  1.1     skrll 	  /* We need a PT_TLS segment.  */
   3584  1.1     skrll 	  ++segs;
   3585  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3586  1.1     skrll 	}
   3587  1.1     skrll     }
   3588  1.1     skrll 
   3589  1.1     skrll   /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need.  */
   3590  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3591  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
   3592  1.1     skrll     {
   3593  1.1     skrll       int a;
   3594  1.1     skrll 
   3595  1.1     skrll       a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
   3596  1.1     skrll       if (a == -1)
   3597  1.1     skrll 	abort ();
   3598  1.1     skrll       segs += a;
   3599  1.1     skrll     }
   3600  1.1     skrll 
   3601  1.1     skrll   return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   3602  1.1     skrll }
   3603  1.1     skrll 
   3604  1.1     skrll /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section.  */
   3605  1.1     skrll 
   3606  1.1     skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *
   3607  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
   3608  1.1     skrll {
   3609  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   3610  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   3611  1.1     skrll 
   3612  1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map,
   3613  1.1     skrll 	 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   3614  1.1     skrll        m != NULL;
   3615  1.1     skrll        m = m->next, p++)
   3616  1.1     skrll     {
   3617  1.1     skrll       int i;
   3618  1.1     skrll 
   3619  1.1     skrll       for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
   3620  1.1     skrll 	if (m->sections[i] == section)
   3621  1.1     skrll 	  return p;
   3622  1.1     skrll     }
   3623  1.1     skrll 
   3624  1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   3625  1.1     skrll }
   3626  1.1     skrll 
   3627  1.1     skrll /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment.  */
   3628  1.1     skrll 
   3629  1.1     skrll static struct elf_segment_map *
   3630  1.1     skrll make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
   3631  1.1     skrll 	      asection **sections,
   3632  1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int from,
   3633  1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int to,
   3634  1.1     skrll 	      bfd_boolean phdr)
   3635  1.1     skrll {
   3636  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   3637  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   3638  1.1     skrll   asection **hdrpp;
   3639  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type amt;
   3640  1.1     skrll 
   3641  1.3  christos   amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   3642  1.1     skrll   amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   3643  1.1     skrll   m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   3644  1.1     skrll   if (m == NULL)
   3645  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   3646  1.1     skrll   m->next = NULL;
   3647  1.1     skrll   m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
   3648  1.1     skrll   for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
   3649  1.1     skrll     m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
   3650  1.1     skrll   m->count = to - from;
   3651  1.1     skrll 
   3652  1.1     skrll   if (from == 0 && phdr)
   3653  1.1     skrll     {
   3654  1.1     skrll       /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment.  */
   3655  1.1     skrll       m->includes_filehdr = 1;
   3656  1.1     skrll       m->includes_phdrs = 1;
   3657  1.1     skrll     }
   3658  1.1     skrll 
   3659  1.1     skrll   return m;
   3660  1.1     skrll }
   3661  1.1     skrll 
   3662  1.1     skrll /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC.  Returns NULL
   3663  1.1     skrll    on failure.  */
   3664  1.1     skrll 
   3665  1.1     skrll struct elf_segment_map *
   3666  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
   3667  1.1     skrll {
   3668  1.3  christos   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   3669  1.3  christos 
   3670  1.1     skrll   m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
   3671  1.1     skrll                                              sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
   3672  1.1     skrll   if (m == NULL)
   3673  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   3674  1.1     skrll   m->next = NULL;
   3675  1.1     skrll   m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
   3676  1.1     skrll   m->count = 1;
   3677  1.1     skrll   m->sections[0] = dynsec;
   3678  1.1     skrll 
   3679  1.1     skrll   return m;
   3680  1.1     skrll }
   3681  1.1     skrll 
   3682  1.1     skrll /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map.  */
   3683  1.1     skrll 
   3684  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   3685  1.1     skrll elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
   3686  1.1     skrll 			struct bfd_link_info *info,
   3687  1.1     skrll 			bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
   3688  1.1     skrll {
   3689  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map **m;
   3690  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   3691  1.1     skrll 
   3692  1.1     skrll   /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
   3693  1.1     skrll      not in PT_LOAD segments.  We ensure this here by removing such
   3694  1.1     skrll      sections from the segment map.  We also remove excluded
   3695  1.1     skrll      sections.  Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
   3696  1.1     skrll      removed.  */
   3697  1.1     skrll   m = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
   3698  1.1     skrll   while (*m)
   3699  1.1     skrll     {
   3700  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, new_count;
   3701  1.1     skrll 
   3702  1.1     skrll       for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
   3703  1.1     skrll 	{
   3704  1.1     skrll 	  if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
   3705  1.1     skrll 	      && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   3706  1.1     skrll 		  || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
   3707  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3708  1.1     skrll 	      (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
   3709  1.1     skrll 	      new_count++;
   3710  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3711  1.1     skrll 	}
   3712  1.1     skrll       (*m)->count = new_count;
   3713  1.1     skrll 
   3714  1.1     skrll       if (remove_empty_load && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD && (*m)->count == 0)
   3715  1.1     skrll 	*m = (*m)->next;
   3716  1.1     skrll       else
   3717  1.1     skrll 	m = &(*m)->next;
   3718  1.1     skrll     }
   3719  1.1     skrll 
   3720  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3721  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
   3722  1.1     skrll     {
   3723  1.1     skrll       if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
   3724  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   3725  1.1     skrll     }
   3726  1.1     skrll 
   3727  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   3728  1.1     skrll }
   3729  1.1     skrll 
   3730  1.1     skrll /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments.  */
   3731  1.1     skrll 
   3732  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   3733  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3734  1.1     skrll {
   3735  1.1     skrll   unsigned int count;
   3736  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   3737  1.1     skrll   asection **sections = NULL;
   3738  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3739  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
   3740  1.1     skrll 
   3741  1.1     skrll   no_user_phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map == NULL;
   3742  1.1     skrll   if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
   3743  1.1     skrll     {
   3744  1.1     skrll       asection *s;
   3745  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   3746  1.1     skrll       struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
   3747  1.1     skrll       struct elf_segment_map **pm;
   3748  1.1     skrll       asection *last_hdr;
   3749  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma last_size;
   3750  1.1     skrll       unsigned int phdr_index;
   3751  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma maxpagesize;
   3752  1.1     skrll       asection **hdrpp;
   3753  1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
   3754  1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean writable;
   3755  1.1     skrll       int tls_count = 0;
   3756  1.1     skrll       asection *first_tls = NULL;
   3757  1.3  christos       asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
   3758  1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type amt;
   3759  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
   3760  1.1     skrll 
   3761  1.3  christos       /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them.  */
   3762  1.3  christos 
   3763  1.1     skrll       sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
   3764  1.1     skrll                                             sizeof (asection *));
   3765  1.1     skrll       if (sections == NULL)
   3766  1.3  christos 	goto error_return;
   3767  1.3  christos 
   3768  1.3  christos       /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
   3769  1.3  christos 	 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
   3770  1.3  christos 	 being shifted.  */
   3771  1.3  christos       addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
   3772  1.1     skrll       addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
   3773  1.1     skrll 
   3774  1.1     skrll       i = 0;
   3775  1.1     skrll       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   3776  1.1     skrll 	{
   3777  1.1     skrll 	  if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   3778  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3779  1.3  christos 	      sections[i] = s;
   3780  1.3  christos 	      ++i;
   3781  1.3  christos 	      /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header.  */
   3782  1.1     skrll 	      if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
   3783  1.1     skrll 		wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
   3784  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3785  1.1     skrll 	}
   3786  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
   3787  1.1     skrll       count = i;
   3788  1.1     skrll 
   3789  1.1     skrll       qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
   3790  1.1     skrll 
   3791  1.1     skrll       /* Build the mapping.  */
   3792  1.1     skrll 
   3793  1.1     skrll       mfirst = NULL;
   3794  1.1     skrll       pm = &mfirst;
   3795  1.1     skrll 
   3796  1.1     skrll       /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
   3797  1.1     skrll 	 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
   3798  1.1     skrll 	 section.  */
   3799  1.1     skrll       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
   3800  1.1     skrll       if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   3801  1.3  christos 	{
   3802  1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   3803  1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   3804  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   3805  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   3806  1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   3807  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
   3808  1.1     skrll 	  /* FIXME: UnixWare and Solaris set PF_X, Irix 5 does not.  */
   3809  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_X;
   3810  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   3811  1.1     skrll 	  m->includes_phdrs = 1;
   3812  1.1     skrll 
   3813  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   3814  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   3815  1.3  christos 
   3816  1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   3817  1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   3818  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   3819  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   3820  1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   3821  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
   3822  1.1     skrll 	  m->count = 1;
   3823  1.1     skrll 	  m->sections[0] = s;
   3824  1.1     skrll 
   3825  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   3826  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   3827  1.1     skrll 	}
   3828  1.1     skrll 
   3829  1.1     skrll       /* Look through the sections.  We put sections in the same program
   3830  1.1     skrll 	 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
   3831  1.1     skrll 	 a few bytes of the end of the first section.  */
   3832  1.1     skrll       last_hdr = NULL;
   3833  1.1     skrll       last_size = 0;
   3834  1.1     skrll       phdr_index = 0;
   3835  1.1     skrll       maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
   3836  1.1     skrll       writable = FALSE;
   3837  1.1     skrll       dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
   3838  1.1     skrll       if (dynsec != NULL
   3839  1.1     skrll 	  && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
   3840  1.1     skrll 	dynsec = NULL;
   3841  1.1     skrll 
   3842  1.1     skrll       /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
   3843  1.1     skrll 	 is not adjacent to the program headers.  This is an
   3844  1.1     skrll 	 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
   3845  1.1     skrll 	 program headers we will need.  */
   3846  1.1     skrll       if (count > 0)
   3847  1.1     skrll 	{
   3848  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size;
   3849  1.1     skrll 
   3850  1.1     skrll 	  if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
   3851  1.3  christos 	    phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
   3852  1.3  christos 	  if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
   3853  1.3  christos 	      || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
   3854  1.3  christos 	      || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
   3855  1.1     skrll 		  < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
   3856  1.1     skrll 	      || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
   3857  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
   3858  1.1     skrll 	}
   3859  1.1     skrll 
   3860  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
   3861  1.1     skrll 	{
   3862  1.1     skrll 	  asection *hdr;
   3863  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_boolean new_segment;
   3864  1.1     skrll 
   3865  1.1     skrll 	  hdr = *hdrpp;
   3866  1.1     skrll 
   3867  1.1     skrll 	  /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
   3868  1.1     skrll 	     segment.  */
   3869  1.1     skrll 
   3870  1.1     skrll 	  if (last_hdr == NULL)
   3871  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3872  1.1     skrll 	      /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
   3873  1.1     skrll 		 one (we build the last one after this loop).  */
   3874  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = FALSE;
   3875  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3876  1.1     skrll 	  else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
   3877  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3878  1.1     skrll 	      /* If this section has a different relation between the
   3879  1.1     skrll 		 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
   3880  1.1     skrll 		 segment.  */
   3881  1.3  christos 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   3882  1.3  christos 	    }
   3883  1.3  christos 	  else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
   3884  1.3  christos 		   || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
   3885  1.3  christos 	    {
   3886  1.3  christos 	      /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
   3887  1.3  christos 		 the previous section, then we need a new segment.  */
   3888  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   3889  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3890  1.1     skrll 	  /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
   3891  1.1     skrll 	     to the end of the address space.  If the aligned address wraps
   3892  1.1     skrll 	     around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
   3893  1.1     skrll 	     pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
   3894  1.1     skrll 	     section can be included in the current segment.  */
   3895  1.1     skrll 	  else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
   3896  1.1     skrll 		    > last_hdr->lma)
   3897  1.1     skrll 		   && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
   3898  1.1     skrll 		       <= hdr->lma))
   3899  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3900  1.1     skrll 	      /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
   3901  1.1     skrll 		 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment.  */
   3902  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   3903  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3904  1.1     skrll 	  else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
   3905  1.1     skrll 		   && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
   3906  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3907  1.1     skrll 	      /* We don't want to put a loadable section after a
   3908  1.1     skrll 		 nonloadable section in the same segment.
   3909  1.1     skrll 		 Consider .tbss sections as loadable for this purpose.  */
   3910  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   3911  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3912  1.1     skrll 	  else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
   3913  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3914  1.1     skrll 	      /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
   3915  1.1     skrll 		 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
   3916  1.1     skrll 		 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment.  */
   3917  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = FALSE;
   3918  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3919  1.3  christos 	  else if (! writable
   3920  1.3  christos 		   && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
   3921  1.1     skrll 		   && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
   3922  1.1     skrll 		       != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
   3923  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3924  1.1     skrll 	      /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
   3925  1.1     skrll 		 segment, unless they are on the same page in memory
   3926  1.1     skrll 		 anyhow.  We already know that the last section does not
   3927  1.1     skrll 		 bring us past the current section on the page, so the
   3928  1.1     skrll 		 only case in which the new section is not on the same
   3929  1.1     skrll 		 page as the previous section is when the previous section
   3930  1.1     skrll 		 ends precisely on a page boundary.  */
   3931  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   3932  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3933  1.1     skrll 	  else
   3934  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3935  1.1     skrll 	      /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment.  */
   3936  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = FALSE;
   3937  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3938  1.1     skrll 
   3939  1.1     skrll 	  /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision.  */
   3940  1.1     skrll 	  if (last_hdr != NULL
   3941  1.1     skrll 	      && info != NULL
   3942  1.1     skrll 	      && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
   3943  1.1     skrll 	    new_segment
   3944  1.1     skrll 	      = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
   3945  1.1     skrll 							      last_hdr,
   3946  1.1     skrll 							      new_segment);
   3947  1.1     skrll 
   3948  1.1     skrll 	  if (! new_segment)
   3949  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3950  1.1     skrll 	      if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   3951  1.1     skrll 		writable = TRUE;
   3952  1.1     skrll 	      last_hdr = hdr;
   3953  1.1     skrll 	      /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size.  */
   3954  1.1     skrll 	      if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
   3955  1.1     skrll 		  != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   3956  1.1     skrll 		last_size = hdr->size;
   3957  1.1     skrll 	      else
   3958  1.1     skrll 		last_size = 0;
   3959  1.1     skrll 	      continue;
   3960  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3961  1.1     skrll 
   3962  1.1     skrll 	  /* We need a new program segment.  We must create a new program
   3963  1.1     skrll 	     header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr.  */
   3964  1.1     skrll 
   3965  1.1     skrll 	  m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
   3966  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   3967  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   3968  1.1     skrll 
   3969  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   3970  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   3971  1.1     skrll 
   3972  1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   3973  1.1     skrll 	    writable = TRUE;
   3974  1.1     skrll 	  else
   3975  1.1     skrll 	    writable = FALSE;
   3976  1.1     skrll 
   3977  1.1     skrll 	  last_hdr = hdr;
   3978  1.1     skrll 	  /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size.  */
   3979  1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   3980  1.1     skrll 	    last_size = hdr->size;
   3981  1.1     skrll 	  else
   3982  1.1     skrll 	    last_size = 0;
   3983  1.1     skrll 	  phdr_index = i;
   3984  1.1     skrll 	  phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
   3985  1.3  christos 	}
   3986  1.3  christos 
   3987  1.3  christos       /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
   3988  1.3  christos 	 for .tbss.  */
   3989  1.3  christos       if (last_hdr != NULL
   3990  1.3  christos 	  && (i - phdr_index != 1
   3991  1.1     skrll 	      || ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
   3992  1.1     skrll 		  != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
   3993  1.1     skrll 	{
   3994  1.1     skrll 	  m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
   3995  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   3996  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   3997  1.1     skrll 
   3998  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   3999  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4000  1.1     skrll 	}
   4001  1.1     skrll 
   4002  1.1     skrll       /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
   4003  1.1     skrll       if (dynsec != NULL)
   4004  1.1     skrll 	{
   4005  1.1     skrll 	  m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
   4006  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4007  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4008  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4009  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4010  1.1     skrll 	}
   4011  1.1     skrll 
   4012  1.1     skrll       /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
   4013  1.1     skrll 	 add a PT_NOTE segment.  We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
   4014  1.1     skrll 	 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
   4015  1.1     skrll 	 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
   4016  1.1     skrll 	 in the output file.  FIXME: Using names for section types is
   4017  1.1     skrll 	 bogus anyhow.  */
   4018  1.1     skrll       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4019  1.1     skrll 	{
   4020  1.1     skrll 	  if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   4021  1.1     skrll 	      && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
   4022  1.3  christos 	    {
   4023  1.3  christos 	      asection *s2;
   4024  1.1     skrll 
   4025  1.1     skrll 	      count = 1;
   4026  1.1     skrll 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4027  1.1     skrll 	      if (s->alignment_power == 2)
   4028  1.1     skrll 		for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
   4029  1.1     skrll 		  {
   4030  1.1     skrll 		    if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
   4031  1.3  christos 			&& (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   4032  1.3  christos 			&& CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
   4033  1.1     skrll 			&& align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
   4034  1.1     skrll 			   == s2->next->lma)
   4035  1.1     skrll 		      count++;
   4036  1.1     skrll 		    else
   4037  1.1     skrll 		      break;
   4038  1.3  christos 		  }
   4039  1.1     skrll 	      amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   4040  1.1     skrll 	      m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4041  1.1     skrll 	      if (m == NULL)
   4042  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return;
   4043  1.1     skrll 	      m->next = NULL;
   4044  1.1     skrll 	      m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
   4045  1.1     skrll 	      m->count = count;
   4046  1.1     skrll 	      while (count > 1)
   4047  1.1     skrll 		{
   4048  1.1     skrll 		  m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
   4049  1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
   4050  1.1     skrll 		  s = s->next;
   4051  1.1     skrll 		}
   4052  1.1     skrll 	      m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
   4053  1.1     skrll 	      BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
   4054  1.1     skrll 	      *pm = m;
   4055  1.1     skrll 	      pm = &m->next;
   4056  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4057  1.1     skrll 	  if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   4058  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4059  1.1     skrll 	      if (! tls_count)
   4060  1.1     skrll 		first_tls = s;
   4061  1.1     skrll 	      tls_count++;
   4062  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4063  1.1     skrll 	}
   4064  1.1     skrll 
   4065  1.1     skrll       /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment.  */
   4066  1.1     skrll       if (tls_count > 0)
   4067  1.1     skrll 	{
   4068  1.3  christos 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4069  1.1     skrll 	  amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   4070  1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4071  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4072  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4073  1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   4074  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_TLS;
   4075  1.1     skrll 	  m->count = tls_count;
   4076  1.1     skrll 	  /* Mandated PF_R.  */
   4077  1.3  christos 	  m->p_flags = PF_R;
   4078  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   4079  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
   4080  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4081  1.1     skrll 	      BFD_ASSERT (first_tls->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL);
   4082  1.1     skrll 	      m->sections[i] = first_tls;
   4083  1.1     skrll 	      first_tls = first_tls->next;
   4084  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4085  1.1     skrll 
   4086  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4087  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4088  1.1     skrll 	}
   4089  1.1     skrll 
   4090  1.1     skrll       /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
   4091  1.1     skrll 	 segment.  */
   4092  1.1     skrll       eh_frame_hdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->eh_frame_hdr;
   4093  1.1     skrll       if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
   4094  1.1     skrll 	  && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   4095  1.3  christos 	{
   4096  1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4097  1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4098  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4099  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4100  1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   4101  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
   4102  1.1     skrll 	  m->count = 1;
   4103  1.1     skrll 	  m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
   4104  1.1     skrll 
   4105  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4106  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4107  1.1     skrll 	}
   4108  1.1     skrll 
   4109  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags)
   4110  1.3  christos 	{
   4111  1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4112  1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4113  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4114  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4115  1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   4116  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
   4117  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_flags = elf_tdata (abfd)->stack_flags;
   4118  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   4119  1.1     skrll 
   4120  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4121  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4122  1.1     skrll 	}
   4123  1.1     skrll 
   4124  1.1     skrll       if (info != NULL && info->relro)
   4125  1.1     skrll 	{
   4126  1.1     skrll 	  for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
   4127  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4128  1.1     skrll 	      if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   4129  1.1     skrll 		{
   4130  1.1     skrll 		  asection *last = m->sections[m->count - 1];
   4131  1.1     skrll 		  bfd_vma vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma;
   4132  1.1     skrll 		  bfd_vma filesz = last->vma - vaddr + last->size;
   4133  1.1     skrll 
   4134  1.1     skrll 		  if (vaddr < info->relro_end
   4135  1.1     skrll 		      && vaddr >= info->relro_start
   4136  1.1     skrll 		      && (vaddr + filesz) >= info->relro_end)
   4137  1.1     skrll 		    break;
   4138  1.1     skrll 		}
   4139  1.1     skrll 	      }
   4140  1.1     skrll 
   4141  1.1     skrll 	  /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty.  */
   4142  1.1     skrll 	  if (m != NULL)
   4143  1.3  christos 	    {
   4144  1.1     skrll 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4145  1.1     skrll 	      m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4146  1.1     skrll 	      if (m == NULL)
   4147  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return;
   4148  1.1     skrll 	      m->next = NULL;
   4149  1.1     skrll 	      m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
   4150  1.1     skrll 	      m->p_flags = PF_R;
   4151  1.1     skrll 	      m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   4152  1.1     skrll 
   4153  1.1     skrll 	      *pm = m;
   4154  1.1     skrll 	      pm = &m->next;
   4155  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4156  1.1     skrll 	}
   4157  1.1     skrll 
   4158  1.1     skrll       free (sections);
   4159  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map = mfirst;
   4160  1.1     skrll     }
   4161  1.1     skrll 
   4162  1.1     skrll   if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
   4163  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   4164  1.1     skrll 
   4165  1.1     skrll   for (count = 0, m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
   4166  1.1     skrll     ++count;
   4167  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4168  1.1     skrll 
   4169  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   4170  1.1     skrll 
   4171  1.1     skrll  error_return:
   4172  1.1     skrll   if (sections != NULL)
   4173  1.1     skrll     free (sections);
   4174  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   4175  1.1     skrll }
   4176  1.1     skrll 
   4177  1.1     skrll /* Sort sections by address.  */
   4178  1.1     skrll 
   4179  1.1     skrll static int
   4180  1.1     skrll elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
   4181  1.1     skrll {
   4182  1.1     skrll   const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
   4183  1.1     skrll   const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
   4184  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type size1, size2;
   4185  1.1     skrll 
   4186  1.1     skrll   /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
   4187  1.1     skrll      place the section into a segment.  */
   4188  1.1     skrll   if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
   4189  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   4190  1.1     skrll   else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
   4191  1.1     skrll     return 1;
   4192  1.1     skrll 
   4193  1.1     skrll   /* Then sort by VMA.  Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
   4194  1.1     skrll      the same, and this will do nothing.  */
   4195  1.1     skrll   if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
   4196  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   4197  1.1     skrll   else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
   4198  1.1     skrll     return 1;
   4199  1.1     skrll 
   4200  1.1     skrll   /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones.  */
   4201  1.1     skrll 
   4202  1.1     skrll #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
   4203  1.1     skrll 
   4204  1.1     skrll   if (TOEND (sec1))
   4205  1.1     skrll     {
   4206  1.1     skrll       if (TOEND (sec2))
   4207  1.1     skrll 	{
   4208  1.1     skrll 	  /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
   4209  1.1     skrll 	     here, but continue to try the next comparison.  */
   4210  1.1     skrll 	  if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
   4211  1.1     skrll 	    return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
   4212  1.1     skrll 	}
   4213  1.1     skrll       else
   4214  1.1     skrll 	return 1;
   4215  1.1     skrll     }
   4216  1.1     skrll   else if (TOEND (sec2))
   4217  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   4218  1.1     skrll 
   4219  1.1     skrll #undef TOEND
   4220  1.1     skrll 
   4221  1.1     skrll   /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
   4222  1.1     skrll      before others at the same address.  */
   4223  1.1     skrll 
   4224  1.1     skrll   size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
   4225  1.1     skrll   size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
   4226  1.1     skrll 
   4227  1.1     skrll   if (size1 < size2)
   4228  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   4229  1.1     skrll   if (size1 > size2)
   4230  1.1     skrll     return 1;
   4231  1.1     skrll 
   4232  1.1     skrll   return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
   4233  1.1     skrll }
   4234  1.1     skrll 
   4235  1.1     skrll /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
   4236  1.1     skrll 
   4237  1.1     skrll    We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number.  That's just
   4238  1.1     skrll    not good.  We have to make sure either that the number is not
   4239  1.1     skrll    negative, or that the number has an unsigned type.  When the types
   4240  1.1     skrll    are all the same size they wind up as unsigned.  When file_ptr is a
   4241  1.1     skrll    larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
   4242  1.1     skrll    which is wrong.
   4243  1.1     skrll 
   4244  1.1     skrll    What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
   4245  1.1     skrll    the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
   4246  1.1     skrll    the page size.''  */
   4247  1.1     skrll /* In other words, something like:
   4248  1.1     skrll 
   4249  1.1     skrll    vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
   4250  1.1     skrll    off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
   4251  1.1     skrll    if (vma_offset < off_offset)
   4252  1.1     skrll      adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
   4253  1.1     skrll    else
   4254  1.1     skrll      adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
   4255  1.1     skrll 
   4256  1.1     skrll    which can can be collapsed into the expression below.  */
   4257  1.1     skrll 
   4258  1.1     skrll static file_ptr
   4259  1.1     skrll vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
   4260  1.1     skrll {
   4261  1.1     skrll   return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
   4262  1.1     skrll }
   4263  1.1     skrll 
   4264  1.1     skrll static void
   4265  1.1     skrll print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
   4266  1.1     skrll {
   4267  1.1     skrll   unsigned int j;
   4268  1.1     skrll   const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
   4269  1.1     skrll   char buf[32];
   4270  1.1     skrll 
   4271  1.1     skrll   if (pt == NULL)
   4272  1.1     skrll     {
   4273  1.1     skrll       if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
   4274  1.1     skrll 	sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
   4275  1.1     skrll 		 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
   4276  1.1     skrll       else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
   4277  1.1     skrll 	sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
   4278  1.1     skrll 		 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
   4279  1.1     skrll       else
   4280  1.1     skrll 	snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
   4281  1.1     skrll 		  (unsigned int) m->p_type);
   4282  1.3  christos       pt = buf;
   4283  1.1     skrll     }
   4284  1.1     skrll   fflush (stdout);
   4285  1.1     skrll   fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
   4286  1.1     skrll   for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
   4287  1.3  christos     fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
   4288  1.3  christos   putc ('\n',stderr);
   4289  1.3  christos   fflush (stderr);
   4290  1.3  christos }
   4291  1.3  christos 
   4292  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   4293  1.3  christos write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
   4294  1.3  christos {
   4295  1.3  christos   void *buf;
   4296  1.3  christos   bfd_boolean ret;
   4297  1.3  christos 
   4298  1.3  christos   if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
   4299  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   4300  1.3  christos   buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
   4301  1.3  christos   if (buf == NULL)
   4302  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   4303  1.3  christos   ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
   4304  1.1     skrll   free (buf);
   4305  1.1     skrll   return ret;
   4306  1.1     skrll }
   4307  1.1     skrll 
   4308  1.1     skrll /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
   4309  1.1     skrll    sections to segments.  This function also sets up some fields in
   4310  1.1     skrll    the file header.  */
   4311  1.1     skrll 
   4312  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   4313  1.1     skrll assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
   4314  1.1     skrll 					 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   4315  1.1     skrll {
   4316  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4317  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4318  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
   4319  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   4320  1.1     skrll   file_ptr off;
   4321  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
   4322  1.2     skrll   unsigned int alloc;
   4323  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i, j;
   4324  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
   4325  1.1     skrll 
   4326  1.1     skrll   if (link_info == NULL
   4327  1.1     skrll       && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
   4328  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   4329  1.1     skrll 
   4330  1.2     skrll   alloc = 0;
   4331  1.2     skrll   for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
   4332  1.2     skrll     {
   4333  1.2     skrll       ++alloc;
   4334  1.2     skrll       if (m->header_size)
   4335  1.1     skrll 	header_pad = m->header_size;
   4336  1.1     skrll     }
   4337  1.1     skrll 
   4338  1.1     skrll   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4339  1.1     skrll   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4340  1.1     skrll   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
   4341  1.1     skrll 
   4342  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
   4343  1.1     skrll     elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4344  1.1     skrll   else
   4345  1.1     skrll     BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size
   4346  1.1     skrll 		>= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
   4347  1.1     skrll 
   4348  1.1     skrll   if (alloc == 0)
   4349  1.1     skrll     {
   4350  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4351  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   4352  1.2     skrll     }
   4353  1.2     skrll 
   4354  1.2     skrll   /* We're writing the size in elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size,
   4355  1.2     skrll      see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
   4356  1.2     skrll      that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
   4357  1.2     skrll      The variable alloc contains the computed need, while elf_tdata
   4358  1.2     skrll      (abfd)->program_header_size contains the size used for the
   4359  1.2     skrll      layout.
   4360  1.2     skrll      See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
   4361  1.2     skrll      where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
   4362  1.2     skrll      last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header.  */
   4363  1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
   4364  1.3  christos 	      == 0);
   4365  1.3  christos   phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
   4366  1.3  christos      bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
   4367  1.1     skrll                   (elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
   4368  1.1     skrll                   sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
   4369  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
   4370  1.1     skrll   if (phdrs == NULL)
   4371  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   4372  1.1     skrll 
   4373  1.1     skrll   maxpagesize = 1;
   4374  1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
   4375  1.1     skrll     maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
   4376  1.1     skrll 
   4377  1.2     skrll   off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4378  1.2     skrll   off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4379  1.2     skrll   if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
   4380  1.2     skrll     header_pad = 0;
   4381  1.2     skrll   else
   4382  1.1     skrll     header_pad -= off;
   4383  1.1     skrll   off += header_pad;
   4384  1.1     skrll 
   4385  1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs, j = 0;
   4386  1.1     skrll        m != NULL;
   4387  1.1     skrll        m = m->next, p++, j++)
   4388  1.1     skrll     {
   4389  1.1     skrll       asection **secpp;
   4390  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma off_adjust;
   4391  1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean no_contents;
   4392  1.1     skrll 
   4393  1.1     skrll       /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
   4394  1.1     skrll 	 sections may not be correctly ordered.  NOTE: sorting should
   4395  1.1     skrll 	 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
   4396  1.1     skrll 	 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
   4397  1.1     skrll 	 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly.  */
   4398  1.1     skrll       if (m->count > 1
   4399  1.1     skrll 	  && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
   4400  1.1     skrll 	       && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
   4401  1.1     skrll 	qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
   4402  1.1     skrll 	       elf_sort_sections);
   4403  1.1     skrll 
   4404  1.1     skrll       /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
   4405  1.1     skrll 	 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
   4406  1.1     skrll 	 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
   4407  1.1     skrll 	 that just contribute to p_memsz.  In this loop, OFF tracks next
   4408  1.1     skrll 	 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments.  */
   4409  1.1     skrll       p->p_type = m->p_type;
   4410  1.1     skrll       p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
   4411  1.1     skrll 
   4412  1.1     skrll       if (m->count == 0)
   4413  1.1     skrll 	p->p_vaddr = 0;
   4414  1.1     skrll       else
   4415  1.1     skrll 	p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
   4416  1.1     skrll 
   4417  1.1     skrll       if (m->p_paddr_valid)
   4418  1.1     skrll 	p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
   4419  1.1     skrll       else if (m->count == 0)
   4420  1.1     skrll 	p->p_paddr = 0;
   4421  1.1     skrll       else
   4422  1.1     skrll 	p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
   4423  1.1     skrll 
   4424  1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   4425  1.1     skrll 	  && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
   4426  1.1     skrll 	{
   4427  1.1     skrll 	  /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
   4428  1.1     skrll 	     the maximum page size.  When copying an executable with
   4429  1.1     skrll 	     objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file.  Use this
   4430  1.1     skrll 	     value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
   4431  1.1     skrll 	     may be different.  Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
   4432  1.1     skrll 	     segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
   4433  1.1     skrll 	     on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
   4434  1.1     skrll 	     segment.  */
   4435  1.1     skrll 	  if (m->p_align_valid)
   4436  1.1     skrll 	    maxpagesize = m->p_align;
   4437  1.1     skrll 
   4438  1.1     skrll 	  p->p_align = maxpagesize;
   4439  1.1     skrll 	}
   4440  1.1     skrll       else if (m->p_align_valid)
   4441  1.1     skrll 	p->p_align = m->p_align;
   4442  1.1     skrll       else if (m->count == 0)
   4443  1.1     skrll 	p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
   4444  1.1     skrll       else
   4445  1.1     skrll 	p->p_align = 0;
   4446  1.1     skrll 
   4447  1.1     skrll       no_contents = FALSE;
   4448  1.1     skrll       off_adjust = 0;
   4449  1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   4450  1.1     skrll 	  && m->count > 0)
   4451  1.1     skrll 	{
   4452  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type align;
   4453  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int align_power = 0;
   4454  1.1     skrll 
   4455  1.1     skrll 	  if (m->p_align_valid)
   4456  1.1     skrll 	    align = p->p_align;
   4457  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4458  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4459  1.1     skrll 	      for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
   4460  1.1     skrll 		{
   4461  1.1     skrll 		  unsigned int secalign;
   4462  1.1     skrll 
   4463  1.1     skrll 		  secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
   4464  1.1     skrll 		  if (secalign > align_power)
   4465  1.1     skrll 		    align_power = secalign;
   4466  1.1     skrll 		}
   4467  1.1     skrll 	      align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
   4468  1.1     skrll 	      if (align < maxpagesize)
   4469  1.1     skrll 		align = maxpagesize;
   4470  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4471  1.1     skrll 
   4472  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   4473  1.1     skrll 	    if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
   4474  1.1     skrll 	      /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
   4475  1.1     skrll 		 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
   4476  1.1     skrll 		 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section.  */
   4477  1.1     skrll 	      elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
   4478  1.1     skrll 
   4479  1.1     skrll 	  /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
   4480  1.1     skrll 	     sections.  */
   4481  1.1     skrll 	  no_contents = TRUE;
   4482  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   4483  1.1     skrll 	    if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
   4484  1.1     skrll 	      {
   4485  1.1     skrll 		no_contents = FALSE;
   4486  1.1     skrll 		break;
   4487  1.3  christos 	      }
   4488  1.1     skrll 
   4489  1.1     skrll 	  off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
   4490  1.1     skrll 	  off += off_adjust;
   4491  1.1     skrll 	  if (no_contents)
   4492  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4493  1.1     skrll 	      /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
   4494  1.1     skrll 		 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
   4495  1.1     skrll 		 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
   4496  1.1     skrll 		 checks it.  So to comply with the alignment
   4497  1.1     skrll 		 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
   4498  1.1     skrll 		 p_offset for just this segment.  (OFF_ADJUST is
   4499  1.1     skrll 		 subtracted from OFF later.)  This may put p_offset
   4500  1.1     skrll 		 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter.  */
   4501  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4502  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4503  1.1     skrll 	    off_adjust = 0;
   4504  1.1     skrll 	}
   4505  1.1     skrll       /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
   4506  1.1     skrll 	 PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
   4507  1.1     skrll       else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
   4508  1.1     skrll 	       && m->count > 1
   4509  1.1     skrll 	       && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
   4510  1.1     skrll 	{
   4511  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_error_handler
   4512  1.1     skrll 	    (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment is not the .dynamic section"),
   4513  1.1     skrll 	     abfd);
   4514  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   4515  1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   4516  1.1     skrll 	}
   4517  1.1     skrll       /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE.  */
   4518  1.1     skrll       else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
   4519  1.1     skrll 	for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   4520  1.1     skrll 	  elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
   4521  1.1     skrll 
   4522  1.1     skrll       p->p_offset = 0;
   4523  1.1     skrll       p->p_filesz = 0;
   4524  1.1     skrll       p->p_memsz = 0;
   4525  1.1     skrll 
   4526  1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_filehdr)
   4527  1.1     skrll 	{
   4528  1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   4529  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_flags |= PF_R;
   4530  1.1     skrll 	  p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4531  1.1     skrll 	  p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4532  1.1     skrll 	  if (m->count > 0)
   4533  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4534  1.1     skrll 	      BFD_ASSERT (p->p_type == PT_LOAD);
   4535  1.1     skrll 
   4536  1.1     skrll 	      if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off)
   4537  1.1     skrll 		{
   4538  1.1     skrll 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   4539  1.1     skrll 		    (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers, try linking with -N"),
   4540  1.1     skrll 		     abfd);
   4541  1.1     skrll 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   4542  1.1     skrll 		  return FALSE;
   4543  1.1     skrll 		}
   4544  1.1     skrll 
   4545  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_vaddr -= off;
   4546  1.1     skrll 	      if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
   4547  1.1     skrll 		p->p_paddr -= off;
   4548  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4549  1.1     skrll 	}
   4550  1.1     skrll 
   4551  1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_phdrs)
   4552  1.1     skrll 	{
   4553  1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   4554  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_flags |= PF_R;
   4555  1.1     skrll 
   4556  1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->includes_filehdr)
   4557  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4558  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4559  1.1     skrll 
   4560  1.1     skrll 	      if (m->count > 0)
   4561  1.1     skrll 		{
   4562  1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT (p->p_type == PT_LOAD);
   4563  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
   4564  1.1     skrll 		  if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
   4565  1.1     skrll 		    p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
   4566  1.1     skrll 		}
   4567  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4568  1.1     skrll 
   4569  1.2     skrll 	  p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4570  1.2     skrll 	  p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4571  1.2     skrll 	  if (m->count)
   4572  1.2     skrll 	    {
   4573  1.2     skrll 	      p->p_filesz += header_pad;
   4574  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_memsz += header_pad;
   4575  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4576  1.1     skrll 	}
   4577  1.1     skrll 
   4578  1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   4579  1.1     skrll 	  || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
   4580  1.1     skrll 	{
   4581  1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
   4582  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_offset = off;
   4583  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4584  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4585  1.1     skrll 	      file_ptr adjust;
   4586  1.1     skrll 
   4587  1.1     skrll 	      adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
   4588  1.1     skrll 	      if (!no_contents)
   4589  1.1     skrll 		p->p_filesz += adjust;
   4590  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_memsz += adjust;
   4591  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4592  1.1     skrll 	}
   4593  1.1     skrll 
   4594  1.1     skrll       /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
   4595  1.1     skrll 	 maps.  Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
   4596  1.1     skrll 	 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
   4597  1.1     skrll 	 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
   4598  1.1     skrll 	 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments.  */
   4599  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
   4600  1.1     skrll 	{
   4601  1.1     skrll 	  asection *sec;
   4602  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type align;
   4603  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   4604  1.1     skrll 
   4605  1.1     skrll 	  sec = *secpp;
   4606  1.1     skrll 	  this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
   4607  1.1     skrll 	  align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
   4608  1.1     skrll 
   4609  1.1     skrll 	  if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   4610  1.1     skrll 	       || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
   4611  1.1     skrll 	      && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
   4612  1.1     skrll 		  || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
   4613  1.1     skrll 		      && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
   4614  1.3  christos 			  || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
   4615  1.3  christos 	    {
   4616  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
   4617  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
   4618  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
   4619  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
   4620  1.3  christos 
   4621  1.3  christos 	      if (adjust != 0
   4622  1.1     skrll 		  && (s_start < p_end
   4623  1.1     skrll 		      || p_end < p_start))
   4624  1.3  christos 		{
   4625  1.3  christos 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   4626  1.1     skrll 		    (_("%B: section %A lma %#lx adjusted to %#lx"), abfd, sec,
   4627  1.3  christos 		     (unsigned long) s_start, (unsigned long) p_end);
   4628  1.1     skrll 		  adjust = 0;
   4629  1.1     skrll 		  sec->lma = p_end;
   4630  1.1     skrll 		}
   4631  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_memsz += adjust;
   4632  1.1     skrll 
   4633  1.3  christos 	      if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   4634  1.3  christos 		{
   4635  1.3  christos 		  if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
   4636  1.3  christos 		    {
   4637  1.3  christos 		      /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
   4638  1.3  christos 		         Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
   4639  1.3  christos 			 zero it.  */
   4640  1.3  christos 		      adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
   4641  1.3  christos 		      if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
   4642  1.1     skrll 			return FALSE;
   4643  1.1     skrll 		    }
   4644  1.1     skrll 		  off += adjust;
   4645  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_filesz += adjust;
   4646  1.1     skrll 		}
   4647  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4648  1.1     skrll 
   4649  1.1     skrll 	  if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
   4650  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4651  1.1     skrll 	      /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
   4652  1.1     skrll 		 everything.  */
   4653  1.1     skrll 	      if (i == 0)
   4654  1.1     skrll 		{
   4655  1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
   4656  1.1     skrll 		  off += this_hdr->sh_size;
   4657  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
   4658  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_memsz = 0;
   4659  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_align = 1;
   4660  1.1     skrll 		}
   4661  1.1     skrll 	      else
   4662  1.1     skrll 		{
   4663  1.1     skrll 		  /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written.  */
   4664  1.1     skrll 		  sec->filepos = 0;
   4665  1.1     skrll 		  sec->size = 0;
   4666  1.1     skrll 		  sec->flags = 0;
   4667  1.1     skrll 		  continue;
   4668  1.1     skrll 		}
   4669  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4670  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4671  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4672  1.1     skrll 	      if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   4673  1.1     skrll 		{
   4674  1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
   4675  1.1     skrll 		  if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   4676  1.3  christos 		    off += this_hdr->sh_size;
   4677  1.3  christos 		}
   4678  1.3  christos 	      else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   4679  1.3  christos 		       && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
   4680  1.3  christos 		       && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
   4681  1.3  christos 		{
   4682  1.3  christos 		  /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
   4683  1.3  christos 		     (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
   4684  1.3  christos 		     final PT_LOAD".)  Set sh_offset to the value it
   4685  1.3  christos 		     would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
   4686  1.3  christos 		     p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section.  This
   4687  1.3  christos 		     also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
   4688  1.3  christos 		     p_offset value.  */
   4689  1.3  christos 		  bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
   4690  1.3  christos 							  off, align);
   4691  1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
   4692  1.1     skrll 		}
   4693  1.1     skrll 
   4694  1.1     skrll 	      if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   4695  1.1     skrll 		{
   4696  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   4697  1.1     skrll 		  /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
   4698  1.1     skrll 		     a note section in a PT_NOTE segment.  These take
   4699  1.1     skrll 		     file space but are not loaded into memory.  */
   4700  1.1     skrll 		  if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   4701  1.1     skrll 		    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   4702  1.1     skrll 		}
   4703  1.1     skrll 	      else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   4704  1.1     skrll 		{
   4705  1.1     skrll 		  if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
   4706  1.1     skrll 		    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   4707  1.1     skrll 
   4708  1.1     skrll 		  /* .tbss is special.  It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
   4709  1.1     skrll 		     normal segments.  */
   4710  1.1     skrll 		  else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
   4711  1.1     skrll 		    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   4712  1.1     skrll 		}
   4713  1.1     skrll 
   4714  1.1     skrll 	      if (align > p->p_align
   4715  1.1     skrll 		  && !m->p_align_valid
   4716  1.1     skrll 		  && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
   4717  1.1     skrll 		      || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
   4718  1.1     skrll 		p->p_align = align;
   4719  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4720  1.1     skrll 
   4721  1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   4722  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4723  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_flags |= PF_R;
   4724  1.1     skrll 	      if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
   4725  1.1     skrll 		p->p_flags |= PF_X;
   4726  1.1     skrll 	      if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
   4727  1.1     skrll 		p->p_flags |= PF_W;
   4728  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4729  1.1     skrll 	}
   4730  1.1     skrll       off -= off_adjust;
   4731  1.1     skrll 
   4732  1.1     skrll       /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
   4733  1.3  christos 	 Don't check funky gdb generated core files.  */
   4734  1.3  christos       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
   4735  1.1     skrll 	{
   4736  1.3  christos 	  bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
   4737  1.3  christos 
   4738  1.3  christos 	  for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
   4739  1.3  christos 	    if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
   4740  1.3  christos 		&& ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
   4741  1.3  christos 				       ->this_hdr), p) != 0
   4742  1.1     skrll 		&& ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
   4743  1.3  christos 				       ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
   4744  1.3  christos 	      {
   4745  1.3  christos 		/* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment.  */
   4746  1.1     skrll 		check_vma = FALSE;
   4747  1.3  christos 		break;
   4748  1.3  christos 	      }
   4749  1.3  christos 
   4750  1.3  christos 	  for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   4751  1.3  christos 	    {
   4752  1.3  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   4753  1.3  christos 	      asection *sec;
   4754  1.3  christos 
   4755  1.3  christos 	      sec = m->sections[i];
   4756  1.3  christos 	      this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
   4757  1.3  christos 	      if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
   4758  1.3  christos 		  && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
   4759  1.3  christos 		{
   4760  1.3  christos 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   4761  1.3  christos 		    (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
   4762  1.3  christos 		     abfd, sec, j);
   4763  1.3  christos 		  print_segment_map (m);
   4764  1.3  christos 		}
   4765  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4766  1.1     skrll 	}
   4767  1.1     skrll     }
   4768  1.1     skrll 
   4769  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
   4770  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   4771  1.1     skrll }
   4772  1.1     skrll 
   4773  1.1     skrll /* Assign file positions for the other sections.  */
   4774  1.1     skrll 
   4775  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   4776  1.1     skrll assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
   4777  1.1     skrll 					     struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   4778  1.1     skrll {
   4779  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4780  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
   4781  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
   4782  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
   4783  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   4784  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4785  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
   4786  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
   4787  1.1     skrll   file_ptr off;
   4788  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_sec;
   4789  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   4790  1.1     skrll   unsigned int count;
   4791  1.1     skrll 
   4792  1.1     skrll   i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   4793  1.1     skrll   num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   4794  1.1     skrll   off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
   4795  1.1     skrll   for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
   4796  1.1     skrll     {
   4797  1.1     skrll       struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
   4798  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   4799  1.1     skrll 
   4800  1.1     skrll       hdr = *hdrpp;
   4801  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
   4802  1.1     skrll 	  && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
   4803  1.1     skrll 	      || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   4804  1.1     skrll 		  && hdr->contents == NULL)))
   4805  1.1     skrll 	BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
   4806  1.3  christos       else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   4807  1.3  christos 	{
   4808  1.3  christos 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   4809  1.3  christos 	    (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
   4810  1.3  christos 	     abfd,
   4811  1.3  christos 	     (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
   4812  1.1     skrll 	      ? "*unknown*"
   4813  1.1     skrll 	      : hdr->bfd_section->name));
   4814  1.1     skrll 	  /* We don't need to page align empty sections.  */
   4815  1.1     skrll 	  if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
   4816  1.1     skrll 	    off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
   4817  1.1     skrll 					  bed->maxpagesize);
   4818  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4819  1.1     skrll 	    off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
   4820  1.1     skrll 					  hdr->sh_addralign);
   4821  1.1     skrll 	  off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
   4822  1.1     skrll 							   FALSE);
   4823  1.1     skrll 	}
   4824  1.1     skrll       else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   4825  1.1     skrll 		&& hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
   4826  1.1     skrll 	       || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->symtab_section]
   4827  1.1     skrll 	       || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->symtab_shndx_section]
   4828  1.1     skrll 	       || hdr == i_shdrpp[tdata->strtab_section])
   4829  1.1     skrll 	hdr->sh_offset = -1;
   4830  1.1     skrll       else
   4831  1.1     skrll 	off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   4832  1.1     skrll     }
   4833  1.1     skrll 
   4834  1.1     skrll   /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
   4835  1.1     skrll      the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments.  */
   4836  1.1     skrll   count = 0;
   4837  1.1     skrll   filehdr_vaddr = 0;
   4838  1.1     skrll   filehdr_paddr = 0;
   4839  1.1     skrll   phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4840  1.1     skrll   phdrs_paddr = 0;
   4841  1.1     skrll   phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   4842  1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs;
   4843  1.1     skrll        m != NULL;
   4844  1.1     skrll        m = m->next, p++)
   4845  1.1     skrll     {
   4846  1.1     skrll       ++count;
   4847  1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   4848  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   4849  1.1     skrll 
   4850  1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_filehdr)
   4851  1.1     skrll 	{
   4852  1.1     skrll 	  filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
   4853  1.1     skrll 	  filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
   4854  1.1     skrll 	}
   4855  1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_phdrs)
   4856  1.1     skrll 	{
   4857  1.1     skrll 	  phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
   4858  1.1     skrll 	  phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
   4859  1.1     skrll 	  if (m->includes_filehdr)
   4860  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4861  1.1     skrll 	      phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4862  1.1     skrll 	      phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4863  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4864  1.1     skrll 	}
   4865  1.1     skrll     }
   4866  1.1     skrll 
   4867  1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map, p = phdrs;
   4868  1.1     skrll        m != NULL;
   4869  1.1     skrll        m = m->next, p++)
   4870  1.1     skrll     {
   4871  1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
   4872  1.1     skrll 	{
   4873  1.1     skrll 	  const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
   4874  1.1     skrll 
   4875  1.1     skrll 	  BFD_ASSERT (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs);
   4876  1.1     skrll 
   4877  1.1     skrll 	  if (link_info != NULL)
   4878  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4879  1.1     skrll 	      /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
   4880  1.1     skrll 		 in link_info.  */
   4881  1.1     skrll 	      for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
   4882  1.1     skrll 		{
   4883  1.1     skrll 		  if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
   4884  1.1     skrll 		      && lp->p_vaddr >= link_info->relro_start
   4885  1.1     skrll 		      && lp->p_vaddr < link_info->relro_end
   4886  1.1     skrll 		      && lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz >= link_info->relro_end)
   4887  1.1     skrll 		    break;
   4888  1.1     skrll 		}
   4889  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4890  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4891  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4892  1.1     skrll 	      /* Otherwise we are copying an executable or shared
   4893  1.1     skrll 		 library, but we need to use the same linker logic.  */
   4894  1.1     skrll 	      for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
   4895  1.1     skrll 		{
   4896  1.1     skrll 		  if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
   4897  1.1     skrll 		      && lp->p_paddr == p->p_paddr)
   4898  1.1     skrll 		    break;
   4899  1.1     skrll 		}
   4900  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4901  1.1     skrll 
   4902  1.1     skrll 	  if (lp < phdrs + count)
   4903  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4904  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
   4905  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
   4906  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
   4907  1.1     skrll 	      if (link_info != NULL)
   4908  1.1     skrll 		p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
   4909  1.1     skrll 	      else if (m->p_size_valid)
   4910  1.1     skrll 		p->p_filesz = m->p_size;
   4911  1.1     skrll 	      else
   4912  1.1     skrll 		abort ();
   4913  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
   4914  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_align = 1;
   4915  1.3  christos 	      p->p_flags = (lp->p_flags & ~PF_W);
   4916  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4917  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4918  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4919  1.1     skrll 	      memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
   4920  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_type = PT_NULL;
   4921  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4922  1.1     skrll 	}
   4923  1.1     skrll       else if (m->count != 0)
   4924  1.1     skrll 	{
   4925  1.1     skrll 	  if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
   4926  1.1     skrll 	      && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
   4927  1.1     skrll 		  || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
   4928  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4929  1.3  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs);
   4930  1.1     skrll 
   4931  1.3  christos 	      p->p_filesz = 0;
   4932  1.3  christos 	      p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
   4933  1.3  christos 	      for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
   4934  1.3  christos 		{
   4935  1.3  christos 		  asection *sect = m->sections[i];
   4936  1.3  christos 		  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
   4937  1.3  christos 		  if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   4938  1.3  christos 		    {
   4939  1.3  christos 		      p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
   4940  1.3  christos 				     + hdr->sh_size);
   4941  1.3  christos 		      break;
   4942  1.1     skrll 		    }
   4943  1.1     skrll 		}
   4944  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4945  1.1     skrll 	}
   4946  1.1     skrll       else if (m->includes_filehdr)
   4947  1.1     skrll 	{
   4948  1.1     skrll 	  p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
   4949  1.1     skrll 	  if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
   4950  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
   4951  1.1     skrll 	}
   4952  1.1     skrll       else if (m->includes_phdrs)
   4953  1.1     skrll 	{
   4954  1.1     skrll 	  p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
   4955  1.1     skrll 	  if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
   4956  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
   4957  1.1     skrll 	}
   4958  1.1     skrll     }
   4959  1.1     skrll 
   4960  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
   4961  1.1     skrll 
   4962  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   4963  1.1     skrll }
   4964  1.1     skrll 
   4965  1.1     skrll /* Work out the file positions of all the sections.  This is called by
   4966  1.1     skrll    _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions.  All the section sizes and
   4967  1.1     skrll    VMAs must be known before this is called.
   4968  1.1     skrll 
   4969  1.1     skrll    Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
   4970  1.1     skrll    "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
   4971  1.1     skrll    those that bfd doesn't process as relocations.  The latter sort are
   4972  1.1     skrll    stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr.   We don't
   4973  1.1     skrll    consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
   4974  1.1     skrll    image.  Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
   4975  1.1     skrll    assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
   4976  1.1     skrll 
   4977  1.1     skrll    We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here.  */
   4978  1.1     skrll 
   4979  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   4980  1.1     skrll assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
   4981  1.1     skrll 				     struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   4982  1.1     skrll {
   4983  1.1     skrll   struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
   4984  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   4985  1.1     skrll   file_ptr off;
   4986  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4987  1.1     skrll 
   4988  1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
   4989  1.1     skrll       && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
   4990  1.1     skrll     {
   4991  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   4992  1.1     skrll       unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   4993  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
   4994  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   4995  1.1     skrll 
   4996  1.1     skrll       /* Start after the ELF header.  */
   4997  1.1     skrll       off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
   4998  1.1     skrll 
   4999  1.1     skrll       /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
   5000  1.1     skrll 	 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
   5001  1.1     skrll 	 the sections in the file is unimportant.  */
   5002  1.1     skrll       for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
   5003  1.1     skrll 	{
   5004  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   5005  1.1     skrll 
   5006  1.1     skrll 	  hdr = *hdrpp;
   5007  1.1     skrll 	  if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   5008  1.1     skrll 	       && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
   5009  1.1     skrll 	      || i == tdata->symtab_section
   5010  1.1     skrll 	      || i == tdata->symtab_shndx_section
   5011  1.1     skrll 	      || i == tdata->strtab_section)
   5012  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5013  1.1     skrll 	      hdr->sh_offset = -1;
   5014  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5015  1.1     skrll 	  else
   5016  1.1     skrll 	    off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   5017  1.1     skrll 	}
   5018  1.1     skrll     }
   5019  1.1     skrll   else
   5020  1.1     skrll     {
   5021  1.1     skrll       unsigned int alloc;
   5022  1.1     skrll 
   5023  1.1     skrll       /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
   5024  1.1     skrll 	 assignment of sections to segments.  */
   5025  1.1     skrll       if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
   5026  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   5027  1.1     skrll 
   5028  1.1     skrll       /* And for non-load sections.  */
   5029  1.1     skrll       if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
   5030  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   5031  1.1     skrll 
   5032  1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
   5033  1.1     skrll 	{
   5034  1.1     skrll 	  if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
   5035  1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
   5036  1.1     skrll 	}
   5037  1.1     skrll 
   5038  1.1     skrll       /* Write out the program headers.  */
   5039  1.1     skrll       alloc = tdata->program_header_size / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   5040  1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
   5041  1.1     skrll 	  || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
   5042  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   5043  1.1     skrll 
   5044  1.1     skrll       off = tdata->next_file_pos;
   5045  1.1     skrll     }
   5046  1.1     skrll 
   5047  1.1     skrll   /* Place the section headers.  */
   5048  1.1     skrll   off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
   5049  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
   5050  1.1     skrll   off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
   5051  1.1     skrll 
   5052  1.1     skrll   tdata->next_file_pos = off;
   5053  1.1     skrll 
   5054  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5055  1.1     skrll }
   5056  1.1     skrll 
   5057  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   5058  1.3  christos prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
   5059  1.1     skrll {
   5060  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;	/* Elf file header, internal form.  */
   5061  1.1     skrll   struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
   5062  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5063  1.1     skrll 
   5064  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   5065  1.1     skrll 
   5066  1.1     skrll   shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
   5067  1.1     skrll   if (shstrtab == NULL)
   5068  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5069  1.1     skrll 
   5070  1.1     skrll   elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
   5071  1.1     skrll 
   5072  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
   5073  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
   5074  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
   5075  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
   5076  1.1     skrll 
   5077  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
   5078  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
   5079  1.1     skrll     bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
   5080  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
   5081  1.1     skrll 
   5082  1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
   5083  1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
   5084  1.1     skrll   else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
   5085  1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
   5086  1.1     skrll   else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
   5087  1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
   5088  1.1     skrll   else
   5089  1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
   5090  1.1     skrll 
   5091  1.1     skrll   switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
   5092  1.1     skrll     {
   5093  1.1     skrll     case bfd_arch_unknown:
   5094  1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
   5095  1.1     skrll       break;
   5096  1.1     skrll 
   5097  1.1     skrll       /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
   5098  1.1     skrll 	 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
   5099  1.1     skrll 	 in the corresponding bfd definition.  To avoid duplication,
   5100  1.1     skrll 	 the switch was removed.  Machines that need special handling
   5101  1.1     skrll 	 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
   5102  1.1     skrll 	 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
   5103  1.1     skrll 	 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
   5104  1.1     skrll 	 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it.  */
   5105  1.1     skrll     default:
   5106  1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
   5107  1.1     skrll     }
   5108  1.1     skrll 
   5109  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
   5110  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5111  1.1     skrll 
   5112  1.1     skrll   /* No program header, for now.  */
   5113  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
   5114  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
   5115  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
   5116  1.1     skrll 
   5117  1.1     skrll   /* Each bfd section is section header entry.  */
   5118  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
   5119  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
   5120  1.1     skrll 
   5121  1.1     skrll   /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table.  */
   5122  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
   5123  1.1     skrll     /* It all happens later.  */
   5124  1.1     skrll     ;
   5125  1.1     skrll   else
   5126  1.1     skrll     {
   5127  1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
   5128  1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
   5129  1.1     skrll     }
   5130  1.1     skrll 
   5131  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
   5132  1.1     skrll     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
   5133  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
   5134  1.1     skrll     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
   5135  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
   5136  1.1     skrll     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
   5137  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
   5138  1.1     skrll       || elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
   5139  1.1     skrll       || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   5140  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5141  1.1     skrll 
   5142  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5143  1.1     skrll }
   5144  1.1     skrll 
   5145  1.1     skrll /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
   5146  1.1     skrll    of the loadable file image.  */
   5147  1.1     skrll 
   5148  1.1     skrll void
   5149  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_relocs (bfd *abfd)
   5150  1.1     skrll {
   5151  1.1     skrll   file_ptr off;
   5152  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i, num_sec;
   5153  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp;
   5154  1.1     skrll 
   5155  1.1     skrll   off = elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos;
   5156  1.1     skrll 
   5157  1.1     skrll   num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   5158  1.1     skrll   for (i = 1, shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1; i < num_sec; i++, shdrpp++)
   5159  1.1     skrll     {
   5160  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
   5161  1.1     skrll 
   5162  1.1     skrll       shdrp = *shdrpp;
   5163  1.1     skrll       if ((shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   5164  1.1     skrll 	  && shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
   5165  1.1     skrll 	off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
   5166  1.1     skrll     }
   5167  1.1     skrll 
   5168  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->next_file_pos = off;
   5169  1.1     skrll }
   5170  1.1     skrll 
   5171  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   5172  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
   5173  1.1     skrll {
   5174  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5175  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
   5176  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean failed;
   5177  1.1     skrll   unsigned int count, num_sec;
   5178  1.1     skrll 
   5179  1.1     skrll   if (! abfd->output_has_begun
   5180  1.1     skrll       && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
   5181  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5182  1.1     skrll 
   5183  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   5184  1.1     skrll 
   5185  1.1     skrll   failed = FALSE;
   5186  1.1     skrll   bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
   5187  1.1     skrll   if (failed)
   5188  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5189  1.1     skrll 
   5190  1.1     skrll   _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_relocs (abfd);
   5191  1.1     skrll 
   5192  1.1     skrll   /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too...  */
   5193  1.1     skrll   num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   5194  1.1     skrll   for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
   5195  1.1     skrll     {
   5196  1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
   5197  1.1     skrll 	(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]);
   5198  1.1     skrll       if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
   5199  1.1     skrll 	{
   5200  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
   5201  1.1     skrll 
   5202  1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   5203  1.1     skrll 	      || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
   5204  1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
   5205  1.1     skrll 	}
   5206  1.1     skrll     }
   5207  1.1     skrll 
   5208  1.1     skrll   /* Write out the section header names.  */
   5209  1.1     skrll   if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
   5210  1.1     skrll       && (bfd_seek (abfd, elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   5211  1.1     skrll 	  || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
   5212  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5213  1.1     skrll 
   5214  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
   5215  1.1     skrll     (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd,
   5216  1.1     skrll 						elf_tdata (abfd)->linker);
   5217  1.1     skrll 
   5218  1.1     skrll   if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
   5219  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5220  1.1     skrll 
   5221  1.1     skrll   /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0].  */
   5222  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->after_write_object_contents)
   5223  1.1     skrll     return (*elf_tdata (abfd)->after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
   5224  1.1     skrll 
   5225  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5226  1.1     skrll }
   5227  1.1     skrll 
   5228  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   5229  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
   5230  1.1     skrll {
   5231  1.1     skrll   /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file.  */
   5232  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
   5233  1.1     skrll }
   5234  1.1     skrll 
   5235  1.1     skrll /* Given a section, search the header to find them.  */
   5236  1.1     skrll 
   5237  1.1     skrll unsigned int
   5238  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
   5239  1.3  christos {
   5240  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   5241  1.1     skrll   unsigned int sec_index;
   5242  1.1     skrll 
   5243  1.1     skrll   if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
   5244  1.1     skrll       && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
   5245  1.1     skrll     return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
   5246  1.3  christos 
   5247  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
   5248  1.3  christos     sec_index = SHN_ABS;
   5249  1.1     skrll   else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
   5250  1.3  christos     sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
   5251  1.1     skrll   else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
   5252  1.3  christos     sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
   5253  1.1     skrll   else
   5254  1.1     skrll     sec_index = SHN_BAD;
   5255  1.1     skrll 
   5256  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5257  1.3  christos   if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
   5258  1.1     skrll     {
   5259  1.1     skrll       int retval = sec_index;
   5260  1.1     skrll 
   5261  1.1     skrll       if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
   5262  1.1     skrll 	return retval;
   5263  1.3  christos     }
   5264  1.1     skrll 
   5265  1.1     skrll   if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
   5266  1.3  christos     bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
   5267  1.1     skrll 
   5268  1.1     skrll   return sec_index;
   5269  1.1     skrll }
   5270  1.1     skrll 
   5271  1.1     skrll /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
   5272  1.1     skrll    on error.  */
   5273  1.1     skrll 
   5274  1.1     skrll int
   5275  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
   5276  1.1     skrll {
   5277  1.1     skrll   asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
   5278  1.1     skrll   int idx;
   5279  1.1     skrll   flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
   5280  1.1     skrll 
   5281  1.1     skrll   /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
   5282  1.1     skrll      own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
   5283  1.1     skrll      symbol chain, so udata is 0.  When the linker is generating
   5284  1.1     skrll      relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
   5285  1.1     skrll      input sections rather than the output section.  */
   5286  1.1     skrll   if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
   5287  1.1     skrll       && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
   5288  1.1     skrll       && asym_ptr->section)
   5289  1.1     skrll     {
   5290  1.1     skrll       asection *sec;
   5291  1.1     skrll       int indx;
   5292  1.1     skrll 
   5293  1.1     skrll       sec = asym_ptr->section;
   5294  1.1     skrll       if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
   5295  1.1     skrll 	sec = sec->output_section;
   5296  1.1     skrll       if (sec->owner == abfd
   5297  1.1     skrll 	  && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
   5298  1.1     skrll 	  && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
   5299  1.1     skrll 	asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
   5300  1.1     skrll     }
   5301  1.1     skrll 
   5302  1.1     skrll   idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
   5303  1.1     skrll 
   5304  1.1     skrll   if (idx == 0)
   5305  1.1     skrll     {
   5306  1.1     skrll       /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
   5307  1.1     skrll 	 which is used in a relocation entry.  */
   5308  1.1     skrll       (*_bfd_error_handler)
   5309  1.1     skrll 	(_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
   5310  1.1     skrll 	 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
   5311  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
   5312  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   5313  1.1     skrll     }
   5314  1.1     skrll 
   5315  1.1     skrll #if DEBUG & 4
   5316  1.3  christos   {
   5317  1.3  christos     fprintf (stderr,
   5318  1.1     skrll 	     "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8lx\n",
   5319  1.1     skrll 	     (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, (long) flags);
   5320  1.1     skrll     fflush (stderr);
   5321  1.1     skrll   }
   5322  1.1     skrll #endif
   5323  1.1     skrll 
   5324  1.1     skrll   return idx;
   5325  1.1     skrll }
   5326  1.1     skrll 
   5327  1.1     skrll /* Rewrite program header information.  */
   5328  1.1     skrll 
   5329  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   5330  1.1     skrll rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   5331  1.1     skrll {
   5332  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
   5333  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map;
   5334  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
   5335  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
   5336  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   5337  1.1     skrll   asection *section;
   5338  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   5339  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_segments;
   5340  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
   5341  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
   5342  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma maxpagesize;
   5343  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
   5344  1.1     skrll   unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
   5345  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   5346  1.1     skrll 
   5347  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
   5348  1.1     skrll   iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
   5349  1.1     skrll 
   5350  1.1     skrll   map_first = NULL;
   5351  1.1     skrll   pointer_to_map = &map_first;
   5352  1.1     skrll 
   5353  1.1     skrll   num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   5354  1.1     skrll   maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
   5355  1.1     skrll 
   5356  1.1     skrll   /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1.  */
   5357  1.1     skrll #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start)					\
   5358  1.1     skrll   (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz			\
   5359  1.1     skrll 	    ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
   5360  1.1     skrll 
   5361  1.1     skrll #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment)					\
   5362  1.1     skrll   (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))		\
   5363  1.1     skrll     != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS)			\
   5364  1.1     skrll    ? section->size : 0)
   5365  1.1     skrll 
   5366  1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
   5367  1.1     skrll      the given segment.  VMA addresses are compared.  */
   5368  1.1     skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment)				\
   5369  1.1     skrll   (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr					\
   5370  1.1     skrll    && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment)			\
   5371  1.1     skrll        <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
   5372  1.1     skrll 
   5373  1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
   5374  1.1     skrll      the given segment.  LMA addresses are compared.  */
   5375  1.1     skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base)			\
   5376  1.1     skrll   (section->lma >= base							\
   5377  1.1     skrll    && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment)			\
   5378  1.1     skrll        <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
   5379  1.1     skrll 
   5380  1.1     skrll   /* Handle PT_NOTE segment.  */
   5381  1.1     skrll #define IS_NOTE(p, s)							\
   5382  1.1     skrll   (p->p_type == PT_NOTE							\
   5383  1.1     skrll    && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE					\
   5384  1.1     skrll    && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset				\
   5385  1.1     skrll    && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size					\
   5386  1.1     skrll        <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
   5387  1.1     skrll 
   5388  1.1     skrll   /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
   5389  1.1     skrll      etc.  */
   5390  1.1     skrll #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s)						\
   5391  1.1     skrll   (IS_NOTE (p, s)							\
   5392  1.1     skrll    && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core					\
   5393  1.1     skrll    && s->vma == 0							\
   5394  1.1     skrll    && s->lma == 0)
   5395  1.1     skrll 
   5396  1.1     skrll   /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
   5397  1.1     skrll      linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
   5398  1.1     skrll      p_memsz set to 0.  */
   5399  1.1     skrll #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s)					\
   5400  1.1     skrll   (p->p_vaddr == 0							\
   5401  1.1     skrll    && p->p_paddr == 0							\
   5402  1.1     skrll    && p->p_memsz == 0							\
   5403  1.1     skrll    && p->p_filesz > 0							\
   5404  1.1     skrll    && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0				\
   5405  1.1     skrll    && s->size > 0							\
   5406  1.1     skrll    && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset				\
   5407  1.1     skrll    && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size					\
   5408  1.1     skrll        <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
   5409  1.1     skrll 
   5410  1.1     skrll   /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
   5411  1.1     skrll      A section will be included if:
   5412  1.1     skrll        1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
   5413  1.1     skrll 	  if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
   5414  1.1     skrll        2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
   5415  1.1     skrll 	  segment.
   5416  1.1     skrll        3. There is an output section associated with it,
   5417  1.1     skrll        4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
   5418  1.1     skrll        5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
   5419  1.1     skrll        6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
   5420  1.1     skrll        7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
   5421  1.1     skrll        8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
   5422  1.1     skrll 	  (with the possible exception of .dynamic).  */
   5423  1.1     skrll #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed)		\
   5424  1.1     skrll   ((((segment->p_paddr							\
   5425  1.1     skrll       ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr)	\
   5426  1.1     skrll       : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment))				\
   5427  1.1     skrll      && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)				\
   5428  1.1     skrll     || IS_NOTE (segment, section))					\
   5429  1.1     skrll    && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK					\
   5430  1.1     skrll    && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS					\
   5431  1.1     skrll        || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))				\
   5432  1.1     skrll    && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD					\
   5433  1.1     skrll        || segment->p_type == PT_TLS					\
   5434  1.1     skrll        || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)			\
   5435  1.1     skrll    && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC					\
   5436  1.1     skrll        || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0				\
   5437  1.1     skrll        || (segment->p_paddr						\
   5438  1.1     skrll 	   ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma				\
   5439  1.1     skrll 	   : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma)				\
   5440  1.1     skrll        || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic")	\
   5441  1.1     skrll 	   == 0))							\
   5442  1.1     skrll    && !section->segment_mark)
   5443  1.1     skrll 
   5444  1.1     skrll /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
   5445  1.1     skrll    it is removed from the corresponding output segment.   */
   5446  1.1     skrll #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed)		\
   5447  1.1     skrll   (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed)		\
   5448  1.1     skrll    && section->output_section != NULL)
   5449  1.1     skrll 
   5450  1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2.  */
   5451  1.1     skrll #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field)			\
   5452  1.1     skrll   (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
   5453  1.1     skrll 
   5454  1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
   5455  1.1     skrll      their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
   5456  1.1     skrll      It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
   5457  1.1     skrll      ranges.  RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
   5458  1.1     skrll      to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
   5459  1.1     skrll      LMA.  */
   5460  1.1     skrll #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2)					\
   5461  1.1     skrll   (   !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr)			\
   5462  1.1     skrll 	|| SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr))			\
   5463  1.1     skrll    && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr)			\
   5464  1.1     skrll 	|| SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
   5465  1.1     skrll 
   5466  1.1     skrll   /* Initialise the segment mark field.  */
   5467  1.1     skrll   for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
   5468  1.1     skrll     section->segment_mark = FALSE;
   5469  1.1     skrll 
   5470  1.1     skrll   /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
   5471  1.1     skrll      p_paddr fields are zero.  When we try to objcopy or strip such a
   5472  1.1     skrll      file, we get confused.  Check for this case, and if we find it
   5473  1.1     skrll      don't set the p_paddr_valid fields.  */
   5474  1.1     skrll   p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
   5475  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   5476  1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   5477  1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   5478  1.1     skrll     if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
   5479  1.1     skrll       {
   5480  1.1     skrll 	p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
   5481  1.1     skrll 	break;
   5482  1.1     skrll       }
   5483  1.1     skrll 
   5484  1.1     skrll   /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
   5485  1.1     skrll      of the input BFD.  For this first scan we look for overlaps
   5486  1.1     skrll      in the loadable segments.  These can be created by weird
   5487  1.1     skrll      parameters to objcopy.  Also, fix some solaris weirdness.  */
   5488  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   5489  1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   5490  1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   5491  1.1     skrll     {
   5492  1.1     skrll       unsigned int j;
   5493  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
   5494  1.1     skrll 
   5495  1.1     skrll       if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
   5496  1.1     skrll 	for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
   5497  1.1     skrll 	  if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
   5498  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5499  1.1     skrll 	      /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
   5500  1.1     skrll 		 assignment code will work.  */
   5501  1.1     skrll 	      segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
   5502  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   5503  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5504  1.1     skrll 
   5505  1.1     skrll       if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   5506  1.1     skrll 	{
   5507  1.1     skrll 	  /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  */
   5508  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
   5509  1.1     skrll 	    segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
   5510  1.1     skrll 	  continue;
   5511  1.1     skrll 	}
   5512  1.1     skrll 
   5513  1.1     skrll       /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments.  */
   5514  1.1     skrll       for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
   5515  1.1     skrll 	{
   5516  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
   5517  1.1     skrll 
   5518  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
   5519  1.1     skrll 	      || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
   5520  1.1     skrll 	    continue;
   5521  1.1     skrll 
   5522  1.1     skrll 	  /* Merge the two segments together.  */
   5523  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
   5524  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5525  1.1     skrll 	      /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
   5526  1.1     skrll 		 SEGMENT.  */
   5527  1.1     skrll 	      extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
   5528  1.1     skrll 			      - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
   5529  1.1     skrll 
   5530  1.1     skrll 	      if (extra_length > 0)
   5531  1.1     skrll 		{
   5532  1.1     skrll 		  segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
   5533  1.1     skrll 		  segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
   5534  1.1     skrll 		}
   5535  1.1     skrll 
   5536  1.1     skrll 	      segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
   5537  1.1     skrll 
   5538  1.1     skrll 	      /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop.  */
   5539  1.1     skrll 	      i = 0;
   5540  1.1     skrll 	      segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   5541  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   5542  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5543  1.1     skrll 	  else
   5544  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5545  1.1     skrll 	      /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
   5546  1.1     skrll 		 SEGMENT2.  */
   5547  1.1     skrll 	      extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
   5548  1.1     skrll 			      - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
   5549  1.1     skrll 
   5550  1.1     skrll 	      if (extra_length > 0)
   5551  1.1     skrll 		{
   5552  1.1     skrll 		  segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
   5553  1.1     skrll 		  segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
   5554  1.1     skrll 		}
   5555  1.1     skrll 
   5556  1.1     skrll 	      segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
   5557  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5558  1.1     skrll 	}
   5559  1.1     skrll     }
   5560  1.1     skrll 
   5561  1.1     skrll   /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments.  */
   5562  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   5563  1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   5564  1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   5565  1.1     skrll     {
   5566  1.1     skrll       unsigned int section_count;
   5567  1.1     skrll       asection **sections;
   5568  1.1     skrll       asection *output_section;
   5569  1.1     skrll       unsigned int isec;
   5570  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma matching_lma;
   5571  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma suggested_lma;
   5572  1.1     skrll       unsigned int j;
   5573  1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type amt;
   5574  1.1     skrll       asection *first_section;
   5575  1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
   5576  1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
   5577  1.1     skrll 
   5578  1.1     skrll       if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
   5579  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   5580  1.1     skrll 
   5581  1.1     skrll       first_section = NULL;
   5582  1.1     skrll       /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment.  */
   5583  1.1     skrll       for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
   5584  1.1     skrll 	   section != NULL;
   5585  1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   5586  1.1     skrll 	{
   5587  1.1     skrll 	  /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
   5588  1.1     skrll 	     removed from the corresponding output segment.   */
   5589  1.1     skrll 	  if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
   5590  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5591  1.1     skrll 	      if (first_section == NULL)
   5592  1.1     skrll 		first_section = section;
   5593  1.1     skrll 	      if (section->output_section != NULL)
   5594  1.1     skrll 		++section_count;
   5595  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5596  1.1     skrll 	}
   5597  1.1     skrll 
   5598  1.1     skrll       /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
   5599  1.1     skrll 	 all of the sections we have selected.  */
   5600  1.3  christos       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   5601  1.1     skrll       amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   5602  1.1     skrll       map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
   5603  1.1     skrll       if (map == NULL)
   5604  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   5605  1.1     skrll 
   5606  1.1     skrll       /* Initialise the fields of the segment map.  Default to
   5607  1.1     skrll 	 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD.  */
   5608  1.1     skrll       map->next = NULL;
   5609  1.1     skrll       map->p_type = segment->p_type;
   5610  1.1     skrll       map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
   5611  1.1     skrll       map->p_flags_valid = 1;
   5612  1.1     skrll 
   5613  1.1     skrll       /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
   5614  1.1     skrll 	 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
   5615  1.1     skrll 	 output segment.  */
   5616  1.1     skrll       if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
   5617  1.1     skrll 	{
   5618  1.1     skrll 	  map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
   5619  1.1     skrll 	  map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
   5620  1.1     skrll 	}
   5621  1.1     skrll 
   5622  1.1     skrll       /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
   5623  1.1     skrll 	 and if it contains the program headers themselves.  */
   5624  1.1     skrll       map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
   5625  1.1     skrll 			       && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
   5626  1.1     skrll       map->includes_phdrs = 0;
   5627  1.1     skrll 
   5628  1.1     skrll       if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   5629  1.1     skrll 	{
   5630  1.1     skrll 	  map->includes_phdrs =
   5631  1.1     skrll 	    (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   5632  1.1     skrll 	     && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
   5633  1.1     skrll 		 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   5634  1.1     skrll 		     + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
   5635  1.1     skrll 
   5636  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
   5637  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_included = TRUE;
   5638  1.1     skrll 	}
   5639  1.1     skrll 
   5640  1.1     skrll       if (section_count == 0)
   5641  1.1     skrll 	{
   5642  1.1     skrll 	  /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
   5643  1.1     skrll 	     no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
   5644  1.1     skrll 	     something.  They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
   5645  1.1     skrll 	     a warning is produced.  */
   5646  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   5647  1.1     skrll 	    (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: warning: Empty loadable segment"
   5648  1.1     skrll 				     " detected, is this intentional ?\n"),
   5649  1.1     skrll 				   ibfd);
   5650  1.1     skrll 
   5651  1.1     skrll 	  map->count = 0;
   5652  1.1     skrll 	  *pointer_to_map = map;
   5653  1.1     skrll 	  pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   5654  1.1     skrll 
   5655  1.1     skrll 	  continue;
   5656  1.1     skrll 	}
   5657  1.1     skrll 
   5658  1.1     skrll       /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
   5659  1.1     skrll 	 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
   5660  1.1     skrll 	 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
   5661  1.1     skrll 	 been moved (ie had its LMA changed).  There are four possibilities:
   5662  1.1     skrll 
   5663  1.1     skrll 	 1. None of the sections have been moved.
   5664  1.1     skrll 	    In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
   5665  1.1     skrll 	    input BFD.
   5666  1.1     skrll 
   5667  1.1     skrll 	 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
   5668  1.1     skrll 	    In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
   5669  1.1     skrll 	    of the first section.
   5670  1.1     skrll 
   5671  1.1     skrll 	 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
   5672  1.1     skrll 	    In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
   5673  1.1     skrll 	    placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
   5674  1.1     skrll 	    and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
   5675  1.1     skrll 	    have to be created to contain the other sections.
   5676  1.1     skrll 
   5677  1.1     skrll 	 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
   5678  1.1     skrll 	    In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
   5679  1.1     skrll 	    of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
   5680  1.1     skrll 	    or segments to contain the other sections.
   5681  1.1     skrll 
   5682  1.1     skrll 	 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
   5683  1.1     skrll 	 pointers that we are interested in.  As these sections get assigned
   5684  1.3  christos 	 to a segment, they are removed from this array.  */
   5685  1.1     skrll 
   5686  1.1     skrll       sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
   5687  1.1     skrll       if (sections == NULL)
   5688  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   5689  1.1     skrll 
   5690  1.1     skrll       /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
   5691  1.1     skrll 	 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
   5692  1.1     skrll 	 Also add the sections to the current segment.  In the common
   5693  1.1     skrll 	 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
   5694  1.1     skrll 	 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
   5695  1.1     skrll 	 more to do.  */
   5696  1.1     skrll       isec = 0;
   5697  1.1     skrll       matching_lma = 0;
   5698  1.1     skrll       suggested_lma = 0;
   5699  1.1     skrll       first_matching_lma = TRUE;
   5700  1.1     skrll       first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
   5701  1.1     skrll 
   5702  1.1     skrll       for (section = ibfd->sections;
   5703  1.1     skrll 	   section != NULL;
   5704  1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   5705  1.1     skrll 	if (section == first_section)
   5706  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   5707  1.1     skrll 
   5708  1.1     skrll       for (j = 0; section != NULL; section = section->next)
   5709  1.1     skrll 	{
   5710  1.1     skrll 	  if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
   5711  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5712  1.1     skrll 	      output_section = section->output_section;
   5713  1.1     skrll 
   5714  1.1     skrll 	      sections[j++] = section;
   5715  1.1     skrll 
   5716  1.1     skrll 	      /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
   5717  1.1     skrll 		 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
   5718  1.1     skrll 		 correct value.  Note - some backends require that
   5719  1.1     skrll 		 p_paddr be left as zero.  */
   5720  1.1     skrll 	      if (!p_paddr_valid
   5721  1.1     skrll 		  && segment->p_vaddr != 0
   5722  1.1     skrll 		  && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
   5723  1.1     skrll 		  && isec == 0
   5724  1.1     skrll 		  && output_section->lma != 0
   5725  1.1     skrll 		  && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
   5726  1.1     skrll 					     + (map->includes_filehdr
   5727  1.1     skrll 						? iehdr->e_ehsize
   5728  1.1     skrll 						: 0)
   5729  1.1     skrll 					     + (map->includes_phdrs
   5730  1.1     skrll 						? (iehdr->e_phnum
   5731  1.1     skrll 						   * iehdr->e_phentsize)
   5732  1.1     skrll 						: 0)))
   5733  1.1     skrll 		map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
   5734  1.1     skrll 
   5735  1.1     skrll 	      /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
   5736  1.1     skrll 		 LMA address of the output section.  */
   5737  1.1     skrll 	      if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
   5738  1.1     skrll 		  || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
   5739  1.1     skrll 		  || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
   5740  1.1     skrll 		      && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
   5741  1.1     skrll 		{
   5742  1.1     skrll 		  if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
   5743  1.1     skrll 		    {
   5744  1.1     skrll 		      matching_lma = output_section->lma;
   5745  1.1     skrll 		      first_matching_lma = FALSE;
   5746  1.1     skrll 		    }
   5747  1.1     skrll 
   5748  1.1     skrll 		  /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
   5749  1.1     skrll 		     then it does not overlap any other section within that
   5750  1.1     skrll 		     segment.  */
   5751  1.1     skrll 		  map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
   5752  1.1     skrll 		}
   5753  1.1     skrll 	      else if (first_suggested_lma)
   5754  1.1     skrll 		{
   5755  1.1     skrll 		  suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
   5756  1.1     skrll 		  first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
   5757  1.1     skrll 		}
   5758  1.1     skrll 
   5759  1.1     skrll 	      if (j == section_count)
   5760  1.1     skrll 		break;
   5761  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5762  1.1     skrll 	}
   5763  1.1     skrll 
   5764  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
   5765  1.1     skrll 
   5766  1.1     skrll       /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
   5767  1.1     skrll 	 if necessary.  */
   5768  1.1     skrll       if (isec == section_count)
   5769  1.1     skrll 	{
   5770  1.1     skrll 	  /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
   5771  1.1     skrll 	     specified.  This is the default case.  Add the segment to
   5772  1.1     skrll 	     the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
   5773  1.1     skrll 	     program header in the input BFD.  */
   5774  1.1     skrll 	  map->count = section_count;
   5775  1.1     skrll 	  *pointer_to_map = map;
   5776  1.1     skrll 	  pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   5777  1.1     skrll 
   5778  1.1     skrll 	  if (p_paddr_valid
   5779  1.1     skrll 	      && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
   5780  1.1     skrll 	      && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
   5781  1.1     skrll 	      && !map->includes_filehdr
   5782  1.1     skrll 	      && !map->includes_phdrs)
   5783  1.1     skrll 	    /* There is some padding before the first section in the
   5784  1.1     skrll 	       segment.  So, we must account for that in the output
   5785  1.1     skrll 	       segment's vma.  */
   5786  1.1     skrll 	    map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
   5787  1.1     skrll 
   5788  1.1     skrll 	  free (sections);
   5789  1.1     skrll 	  continue;
   5790  1.1     skrll 	}
   5791  1.1     skrll       else
   5792  1.1     skrll 	{
   5793  1.1     skrll 	  if (!first_matching_lma)
   5794  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5795  1.1     skrll 	      /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
   5796  1.1     skrll 		 Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
   5797  1.1     skrll 		 LMA of the first section that fitted.  */
   5798  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
   5799  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5800  1.1     skrll 	  else
   5801  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5802  1.1     skrll 	      /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
   5803  1.1     skrll 		 Change the current segment's physical address to match
   5804  1.1     skrll 		 the LMA of the first section.  */
   5805  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
   5806  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5807  1.1     skrll 
   5808  1.1     skrll 	  /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
   5809  1.1     skrll 	     to allow for space taken up by elf headers.  */
   5810  1.1     skrll 	  if (map->includes_filehdr)
   5811  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5812  1.1     skrll 	      if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
   5813  1.1     skrll 		map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
   5814  1.1     skrll 	      else
   5815  1.1     skrll 		{
   5816  1.1     skrll 		  map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
   5817  1.1     skrll 		  map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
   5818  1.1     skrll 		}
   5819  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5820  1.1     skrll 
   5821  1.1     skrll 	  if (map->includes_phdrs)
   5822  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5823  1.1     skrll 	      if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
   5824  1.1     skrll 		{
   5825  1.1     skrll 		  map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
   5826  1.1     skrll 
   5827  1.1     skrll 		  /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
   5828  1.1     skrll 		     of program headers that we will need.  Make a note
   5829  1.1     skrll 		     here of the number we used and the segment we chose
   5830  1.1     skrll 		     to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
   5831  1.1     skrll 		     offset when we know the correct value.  */
   5832  1.1     skrll 		  phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
   5833  1.1     skrll 		  phdr_adjust_seg = map;
   5834  1.1     skrll 		}
   5835  1.1     skrll 	      else
   5836  1.1     skrll 		map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
   5837  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5838  1.1     skrll 	}
   5839  1.1     skrll 
   5840  1.1     skrll       /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
   5841  1.1     skrll 	 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
   5842  1.1     skrll 	 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps.  Once all
   5843  1.1     skrll 	 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
   5844  1.1     skrll 	 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
   5845  1.1     skrll 	 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
   5846  1.1     skrll 	 the loop.  */
   5847  1.1     skrll       isec = 0;
   5848  1.1     skrll       do
   5849  1.1     skrll 	{
   5850  1.1     skrll 	  map->count = 0;
   5851  1.1     skrll 	  suggested_lma = 0;
   5852  1.1     skrll 	  first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
   5853  1.1     skrll 
   5854  1.1     skrll 	  /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit.  */
   5855  1.1     skrll 	  for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
   5856  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5857  1.1     skrll 	      section = sections[j];
   5858  1.1     skrll 
   5859  1.1     skrll 	      if (section == NULL)
   5860  1.1     skrll 		continue;
   5861  1.1     skrll 
   5862  1.1     skrll 	      output_section = section->output_section;
   5863  1.1     skrll 
   5864  1.1     skrll 	      BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
   5865  1.1     skrll 
   5866  1.1     skrll 	      if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
   5867  1.1     skrll 		  || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
   5868  1.1     skrll 		{
   5869  1.1     skrll 		  if (map->count == 0)
   5870  1.1     skrll 		    {
   5871  1.1     skrll 		      /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
   5872  1.1     skrll 			 the beginning of the segment, then something is
   5873  1.1     skrll 			 wrong.  */
   5874  1.1     skrll 		      if (output_section->lma
   5875  1.1     skrll 			  != (map->p_paddr
   5876  1.1     skrll 			      + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
   5877  1.1     skrll 			      + (map->includes_phdrs
   5878  1.1     skrll 				 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
   5879  1.1     skrll 				 : 0)))
   5880  1.1     skrll 			abort ();
   5881  1.1     skrll 		    }
   5882  1.1     skrll 		  else
   5883  1.1     skrll 		    {
   5884  1.1     skrll 		      asection *prev_sec;
   5885  1.1     skrll 
   5886  1.1     skrll 		      prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
   5887  1.1     skrll 
   5888  1.1     skrll 		      /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
   5889  1.1     skrll 			 and the start of this section is more than
   5890  1.1     skrll 			 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment.  */
   5891  1.1     skrll 		      if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
   5892  1.1     skrll 				      maxpagesize)
   5893  1.1     skrll 			   < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
   5894  1.1     skrll 			  || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
   5895  1.1     skrll 			      > output_section->lma))
   5896  1.1     skrll 			{
   5897  1.1     skrll 			  if (first_suggested_lma)
   5898  1.1     skrll 			    {
   5899  1.1     skrll 			      suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
   5900  1.1     skrll 			      first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
   5901  1.1     skrll 			    }
   5902  1.1     skrll 
   5903  1.1     skrll 			  continue;
   5904  1.1     skrll 			}
   5905  1.1     skrll 		    }
   5906  1.1     skrll 
   5907  1.1     skrll 		  map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
   5908  1.1     skrll 		  ++isec;
   5909  1.1     skrll 		  sections[j] = NULL;
   5910  1.1     skrll 		  section->segment_mark = TRUE;
   5911  1.1     skrll 		}
   5912  1.1     skrll 	      else if (first_suggested_lma)
   5913  1.1     skrll 		{
   5914  1.1     skrll 		  suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
   5915  1.1     skrll 		  first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
   5916  1.1     skrll 		}
   5917  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5918  1.1     skrll 
   5919  1.1     skrll 	  BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
   5920  1.1     skrll 
   5921  1.1     skrll 	  /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments.  */
   5922  1.1     skrll 	  *pointer_to_map = map;
   5923  1.1     skrll 	  pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   5924  1.1     skrll 
   5925  1.1     skrll 	  if (isec < section_count)
   5926  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5927  1.1     skrll 	      /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
   5928  1.1     skrll 		 segments.  Create a new segment here, initialise it
   5929  1.1     skrll 		 and carry on looping.  */
   5930  1.3  christos 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   5931  1.1     skrll 	      amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   5932  1.1     skrll 	      map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_alloc (obfd, amt);
   5933  1.1     skrll 	      if (map == NULL)
   5934  1.1     skrll 		{
   5935  1.1     skrll 		  free (sections);
   5936  1.1     skrll 		  return FALSE;
   5937  1.1     skrll 		}
   5938  1.1     skrll 
   5939  1.1     skrll 	      /* Initialise the fields of the segment map.  Set the physical
   5940  1.1     skrll 		 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
   5941  1.1     skrll 		 not yet been assigned.  */
   5942  1.1     skrll 	      map->next = NULL;
   5943  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_type = segment->p_type;
   5944  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
   5945  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_flags_valid = 1;
   5946  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
   5947  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
   5948  1.1     skrll 	      map->includes_filehdr = 0;
   5949  1.1     skrll 	      map->includes_phdrs = 0;
   5950  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5951  1.1     skrll 	}
   5952  1.1     skrll       while (isec < section_count);
   5953  1.1     skrll 
   5954  1.1     skrll       free (sections);
   5955  1.1     skrll     }
   5956  1.1     skrll 
   5957  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map = map_first;
   5958  1.1     skrll 
   5959  1.1     skrll   /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
   5960  1.1     skrll      going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
   5961  1.1     skrll      the offset if necessary.  */
   5962  1.1     skrll   if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
   5963  1.1     skrll     {
   5964  1.1     skrll       unsigned int count;
   5965  1.1     skrll 
   5966  1.1     skrll       for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
   5967  1.1     skrll 	count++;
   5968  1.1     skrll 
   5969  1.1     skrll       if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
   5970  1.1     skrll 	phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
   5971  1.1     skrll 	  -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
   5972  1.1     skrll     }
   5973  1.1     skrll 
   5974  1.1     skrll #undef SEGMENT_END
   5975  1.1     skrll #undef SECTION_SIZE
   5976  1.1     skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
   5977  1.1     skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
   5978  1.1     skrll #undef IS_NOTE
   5979  1.1     skrll #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
   5980  1.1     skrll #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
   5981  1.1     skrll #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
   5982  1.1     skrll #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
   5983  1.1     skrll #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
   5984  1.1     skrll #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
   5985  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5986  1.1     skrll }
   5987  1.1     skrll 
   5988  1.1     skrll /* Copy ELF program header information.  */
   5989  1.1     skrll 
   5990  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   5991  1.1     skrll copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   5992  1.1     skrll {
   5993  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
   5994  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map;
   5995  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
   5996  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
   5997  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   5998  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   5999  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_segments;
   6000  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
   6001  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
   6002  1.1     skrll 
   6003  1.1     skrll   iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
   6004  1.1     skrll 
   6005  1.1     skrll   map_first = NULL;
   6006  1.1     skrll   pointer_to_map = &map_first;
   6007  1.1     skrll 
   6008  1.1     skrll   /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
   6009  1.1     skrll      map->p_paddr_valid.  */
   6010  1.1     skrll   p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
   6011  1.1     skrll   num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   6012  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6013  1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   6014  1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   6015  1.1     skrll     if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
   6016  1.1     skrll       {
   6017  1.1     skrll 	p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
   6018  1.1     skrll 	break;
   6019  1.1     skrll       }
   6020  1.1     skrll 
   6021  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6022  1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   6023  1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   6024  1.1     skrll     {
   6025  1.1     skrll       asection *section;
   6026  1.1     skrll       unsigned int section_count;
   6027  1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type amt;
   6028  1.3  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   6029  1.1     skrll       asection *first_section = NULL;
   6030  1.1     skrll       asection *lowest_section;
   6031  1.1     skrll 
   6032  1.1     skrll       /* Compute how many sections are in this segment.  */
   6033  1.1     skrll       for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
   6034  1.1     skrll 	   section != NULL;
   6035  1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   6036  1.3  christos 	{
   6037  1.1     skrll 	  this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
   6038  1.3  christos 	  if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
   6039  1.3  christos 	    {
   6040  1.1     skrll 	      if (first_section == NULL)
   6041  1.1     skrll 		first_section = section;
   6042  1.1     skrll 	      section_count++;
   6043  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6044  1.1     skrll 	}
   6045  1.1     skrll 
   6046  1.1     skrll       /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
   6047  1.1     skrll 	 all of the sections we have selected.  */
   6048  1.1     skrll       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   6049  1.3  christos       if (section_count != 0)
   6050  1.1     skrll 	amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   6051  1.1     skrll       map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
   6052  1.1     skrll       if (map == NULL)
   6053  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   6054  1.1     skrll 
   6055  1.1     skrll       /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
   6056  1.1     skrll 	 input segment.  */
   6057  1.1     skrll       map->next = NULL;
   6058  1.1     skrll       map->p_type = segment->p_type;
   6059  1.1     skrll       map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
   6060  1.1     skrll       map->p_flags_valid = 1;
   6061  1.1     skrll       map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
   6062  1.1     skrll       map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
   6063  1.1     skrll       map->p_align = segment->p_align;
   6064  1.1     skrll       map->p_align_valid = 1;
   6065  1.3  christos       map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
   6066  1.1     skrll 
   6067  1.1     skrll       if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
   6068  1.1     skrll 	{
   6069  1.1     skrll 	  /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
   6070  1.1     skrll 	     bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
   6071  1.3  christos 	     section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  We won't
   6072  1.1     skrll 	     change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  */
   6073  1.1     skrll 	  map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
   6074  1.1     skrll 	  map->p_size_valid = 1;
   6075  1.1     skrll 	}
   6076  1.1     skrll 
   6077  1.1     skrll       /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
   6078  1.1     skrll 	 and if it contains the program headers themselves.  */
   6079  1.1     skrll       map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
   6080  1.1     skrll 			       && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
   6081  1.1     skrll 
   6082  1.1     skrll       map->includes_phdrs = 0;
   6083  1.1     skrll       if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   6084  1.1     skrll 	{
   6085  1.1     skrll 	  map->includes_phdrs =
   6086  1.1     skrll 	    (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   6087  1.1     skrll 	     && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
   6088  1.1     skrll 		 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   6089  1.1     skrll 		     + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
   6090  1.1     skrll 
   6091  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
   6092  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_included = TRUE;
   6093  1.3  christos 	}
   6094  1.1     skrll 
   6095  1.1     skrll       lowest_section = first_section;
   6096  1.1     skrll       if (section_count != 0)
   6097  1.1     skrll 	{
   6098  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int isec = 0;
   6099  1.1     skrll 
   6100  1.1     skrll 	  for (section = first_section;
   6101  1.1     skrll 	       section != NULL;
   6102  1.1     skrll 	       section = section->next)
   6103  1.3  christos 	    {
   6104  1.1     skrll 	      this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
   6105  1.1     skrll 	      if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
   6106  1.3  christos 		{
   6107  1.3  christos 		  map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
   6108  1.3  christos 		  if (section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
   6109  1.3  christos 		    lowest_section = section;
   6110  1.3  christos 		  if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   6111  1.3  christos 		    {
   6112  1.3  christos 		      bfd_vma seg_off;
   6113  1.3  christos 
   6114  1.3  christos 		      /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
   6115  1.3  christos 			 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
   6116  1.3  christos 			 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
   6117  1.3  christos 			 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
   6118  1.3  christos 			 invalid.  */
   6119  1.3  christos 		      if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   6120  1.3  christos 			seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
   6121  1.3  christos 		      else
   6122  1.3  christos 			seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
   6123  1.3  christos 		      if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
   6124  1.1     skrll 			map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
   6125  1.1     skrll 		    }
   6126  1.1     skrll 		  if (isec == section_count)
   6127  1.1     skrll 		    break;
   6128  1.1     skrll 		}
   6129  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6130  1.3  christos 	}
   6131  1.3  christos 
   6132  1.3  christos       if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
   6133  1.3  christos 	/* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed.  */
   6134  1.3  christos 	map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
   6135  1.3  christos 
   6136  1.3  christos       if (!map->includes_phdrs
   6137  1.3  christos 	  && !map->includes_filehdr
   6138  1.3  christos 	  && map->p_paddr_valid)
   6139  1.3  christos 	/* There is some other padding before the first section.  */
   6140  1.3  christos 	map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
   6141  1.1     skrll 			       - segment->p_paddr);
   6142  1.1     skrll 
   6143  1.1     skrll       map->count = section_count;
   6144  1.1     skrll       *pointer_to_map = map;
   6145  1.1     skrll       pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   6146  1.1     skrll     }
   6147  1.1     skrll 
   6148  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map = map_first;
   6149  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6150  1.1     skrll }
   6151  1.1     skrll 
   6152  1.1     skrll /* Copy private BFD data.  This copies or rewrites ELF program header
   6153  1.1     skrll    information.  */
   6154  1.1     skrll 
   6155  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   6156  1.1     skrll copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   6157  1.1     skrll {
   6158  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   6159  1.1     skrll       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   6160  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   6161  1.1     skrll 
   6162  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
   6163  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   6164  1.1     skrll 
   6165  1.1     skrll   if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
   6166  1.1     skrll     {
   6167  1.1     skrll       /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
   6168  1.1     skrll 	 covered by ELF program header have changed.  */
   6169  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   6170  1.1     skrll       asection *section, *osec;
   6171  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, num_segments;
   6172  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   6173  1.1     skrll       const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   6174  1.1     skrll 
   6175  1.1     skrll       bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
   6176  1.1     skrll 
   6177  1.1     skrll       /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0.  */
   6178  1.1     skrll       if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
   6179  1.1     skrll 	goto rewrite;
   6180  1.1     skrll 
   6181  1.1     skrll       /* Initialize the segment mark field.  */
   6182  1.1     skrll       for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
   6183  1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   6184  1.1     skrll 	section->segment_mark = FALSE;
   6185  1.1     skrll 
   6186  1.1     skrll       num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   6187  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6188  1.1     skrll 	   i < num_segments;
   6189  1.1     skrll 	   i++, segment++)
   6190  1.1     skrll 	{
   6191  1.1     skrll 	  /* PR binutils/3535.  The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
   6192  1.1     skrll 	     and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
   6193  1.1     skrll 	     which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
   6194  1.1     skrll 	     map in this case.  */
   6195  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_paddr == 0
   6196  1.1     skrll 	      && segment->p_memsz == 0
   6197  1.1     skrll 	      && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
   6198  1.1     skrll 	    goto rewrite;
   6199  1.1     skrll 
   6200  1.1     skrll 	  for (section = ibfd->sections;
   6201  1.1     skrll 	       section != NULL; section = section->next)
   6202  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6203  1.1     skrll 	      /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
   6204  1.1     skrll 		 from the input BFD.  */
   6205  1.1     skrll 	      osec = section->output_section;
   6206  1.1     skrll 	      if (osec)
   6207  1.1     skrll 		osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
   6208  1.1     skrll 
   6209  1.3  christos 	      /* Check if this section is covered by the segment.  */
   6210  1.1     skrll 	      this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
   6211  1.1     skrll 	      if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
   6212  1.1     skrll 		{
   6213  1.1     skrll 		  /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
   6214  1.1     skrll 		     removed.  What else do we need to check?  */
   6215  1.1     skrll 		  if (osec == NULL
   6216  1.1     skrll 		      || section->flags != osec->flags
   6217  1.1     skrll 		      || section->lma != osec->lma
   6218  1.1     skrll 		      || section->vma != osec->vma
   6219  1.1     skrll 		      || section->size != osec->size
   6220  1.1     skrll 		      || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
   6221  1.1     skrll 		      || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
   6222  1.1     skrll 		    goto rewrite;
   6223  1.1     skrll 		}
   6224  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6225  1.1     skrll 	}
   6226  1.1     skrll 
   6227  1.1     skrll       /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
   6228  1.1     skrll 	 input BFD.  */
   6229  1.1     skrll       for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
   6230  1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   6231  1.1     skrll 	{
   6232  1.1     skrll 	  if (section->segment_mark == FALSE)
   6233  1.1     skrll 	    goto rewrite;
   6234  1.1     skrll 	  else
   6235  1.1     skrll 	    section->segment_mark = FALSE;
   6236  1.1     skrll 	}
   6237  1.1     skrll 
   6238  1.1     skrll       return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
   6239  1.1     skrll     }
   6240  1.1     skrll 
   6241  1.1     skrll rewrite:
   6242  1.1     skrll   return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
   6243  1.1     skrll }
   6244  1.1     skrll 
   6245  1.1     skrll /* Initialize private output section information from input section.  */
   6246  1.1     skrll 
   6247  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   6248  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
   6249  1.1     skrll 				    asection *isec,
   6250  1.1     skrll 				    bfd *obfd,
   6251  1.1     skrll 				    asection *osec,
   6252  1.1     skrll 				    struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   6253  1.1     skrll 
   6254  1.3  christos {
   6255  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
   6256  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean final_link = link_info != NULL && !link_info->relocatable;
   6257  1.1     skrll 
   6258  1.1     skrll   if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   6259  1.1     skrll       || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   6260  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   6261  1.3  christos 
   6262  1.3  christos   /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
   6263  1.3  christos      section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
   6264  1.1     skrll      set to something different.  For a final link allow some flags
   6265  1.3  christos      that the linker clears to differ.  */
   6266  1.3  christos   if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
   6267  1.3  christos       && (osec->flags == isec->flags
   6268  1.3  christos 	  || (final_link
   6269  1.1     skrll 	      && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
   6270  1.1     skrll 		  & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
   6271  1.1     skrll     elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
   6272  1.1     skrll 
   6273  1.1     skrll   /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags?  */
   6274  1.1     skrll   elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
   6275  1.1     skrll 			       & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
   6276  1.1     skrll 
   6277  1.1     skrll   /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link.  The output
   6278  1.1     skrll      SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
   6279  1.3  christos      to the input group members.  Ignore linker created group section.
   6280  1.1     skrll      See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c.  */
   6281  1.1     skrll   if (!final_link)
   6282  1.1     skrll     {
   6283  1.1     skrll       if (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
   6284  1.1     skrll 	  || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
   6285  1.1     skrll 	{
   6286  1.1     skrll 	  if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
   6287  1.2     skrll 	    elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
   6288  1.1     skrll 	  elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
   6289  1.1     skrll 	  elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
   6290  1.1     skrll 	}
   6291  1.1     skrll     }
   6292  1.1     skrll 
   6293  1.1     skrll   ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
   6294  1.1     skrll 
   6295  1.1     skrll   /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
   6296  1.1     skrll      don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
   6297  1.1     skrll      may be NULL at this point.  */
   6298  1.1     skrll   if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
   6299  1.1     skrll     {
   6300  1.1     skrll       ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
   6301  1.1     skrll       ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
   6302  1.1     skrll       elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
   6303  1.1     skrll     }
   6304  1.1     skrll 
   6305  1.1     skrll   osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
   6306  1.1     skrll 
   6307  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6308  1.1     skrll }
   6309  1.1     skrll 
   6310  1.1     skrll /* Copy private section information.  This copies over the entsize
   6311  1.1     skrll    field, and sometimes the info field.  */
   6312  1.1     skrll 
   6313  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   6314  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
   6315  1.1     skrll 				    asection *isec,
   6316  1.1     skrll 				    bfd *obfd,
   6317  1.1     skrll 				    asection *osec)
   6318  1.1     skrll {
   6319  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
   6320  1.1     skrll 
   6321  1.1     skrll   if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   6322  1.1     skrll       || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   6323  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   6324  1.1     skrll 
   6325  1.1     skrll   ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
   6326  1.1     skrll   ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
   6327  1.1     skrll 
   6328  1.1     skrll   ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
   6329  1.1     skrll 
   6330  1.1     skrll   if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
   6331  1.1     skrll       || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
   6332  1.1     skrll       || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
   6333  1.1     skrll       || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
   6334  1.1     skrll     ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
   6335  1.1     skrll 
   6336  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
   6337  1.1     skrll 					     NULL);
   6338  1.3  christos }
   6339  1.3  christos 
   6340  1.3  christos /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
   6341  1.3  christos    necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
   6342  1.3  christos    the group member sections.  DISCARDED is the value that a section's
   6343  1.3  christos    output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
   6344  1.1     skrll    function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
   6345  1.1     skrll    from the linker.  */
   6346  1.3  christos 
   6347  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   6348  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
   6349  1.1     skrll {
   6350  1.1     skrll   asection *isec;
   6351  1.3  christos 
   6352  1.1     skrll   for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
   6353  1.1     skrll     if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
   6354  1.1     skrll       {
   6355  1.3  christos 	asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
   6356  1.3  christos 	asection *s = first;
   6357  1.1     skrll 	bfd_size_type removed = 0;
   6358  1.1     skrll 
   6359  1.3  christos 	while (s != NULL)
   6360  1.3  christos 	  {
   6361  1.3  christos 	    /* If this member section is being output but the
   6362  1.3  christos 	       SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
   6363  1.3  christos 	       set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data.  */
   6364  1.1     skrll 	    if (s->output_section != discarded
   6365  1.1     skrll 		&& isec->output_section == discarded)
   6366  1.1     skrll 	      {
   6367  1.1     skrll 		elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
   6368  1.3  christos 		elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
   6369  1.3  christos 	      }
   6370  1.3  christos 	    /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
   6371  1.3  christos 	       but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size.  */
   6372  1.3  christos 	    else if (s->output_section == discarded
   6373  1.1     skrll 		     && isec->output_section != discarded)
   6374  1.1     skrll 	      removed += 4;
   6375  1.1     skrll 	    s = elf_next_in_group (s);
   6376  1.1     skrll 	    if (s == first)
   6377  1.3  christos 	      break;
   6378  1.3  christos 	  }
   6379  1.3  christos 	if (removed != 0)
   6380  1.3  christos 	  {
   6381  1.3  christos 	    if (discarded != NULL)
   6382  1.3  christos 	      {
   6383  1.3  christos 		/* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
   6384  1.3  christos 		   adjust the input section size.  This function may
   6385  1.3  christos 		   be called multiple times, so save the original
   6386  1.3  christos 		   size.  */
   6387  1.3  christos 		if (isec->rawsize == 0)
   6388  1.3  christos 		  isec->rawsize = isec->size;
   6389  1.3  christos 		isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
   6390  1.3  christos 	      }
   6391  1.3  christos 	    else
   6392  1.3  christos 	      {
   6393  1.3  christos 		/* Adjust the output section size when called from
   6394  1.3  christos 		   objcopy. */
   6395  1.3  christos 		isec->output_section->size -= removed;
   6396  1.1     skrll 	      }
   6397  1.1     skrll 	  }
   6398  1.1     skrll       }
   6399  1.1     skrll 
   6400  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6401  1.3  christos }
   6402  1.3  christos 
   6403  1.3  christos /* Copy private header information.  */
   6404  1.3  christos 
   6405  1.3  christos bfd_boolean
   6406  1.3  christos _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   6407  1.3  christos {
   6408  1.3  christos   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   6409  1.3  christos       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   6410  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   6411  1.3  christos 
   6412  1.3  christos   /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
   6413  1.3  christos      This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
   6414  1.3  christos      entry point, because the latter is called after the section
   6415  1.3  christos      contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
   6416  1.3  christos      already been worked out.  */
   6417  1.3  christos   if (elf_tdata (obfd)->segment_map == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
   6418  1.3  christos     {
   6419  1.3  christos       if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
   6420  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   6421  1.3  christos     }
   6422  1.3  christos 
   6423  1.3  christos   return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
   6424  1.1     skrll }
   6425  1.1     skrll 
   6426  1.1     skrll /* Copy private symbol information.  If this symbol is in a section
   6427  1.1     skrll    which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
   6428  1.1     skrll    index correctly.  We use special macro definitions for the mapped
   6429  1.1     skrll    section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
   6430  1.1     skrll    swap_out_syms function.  */
   6431  1.1     skrll 
   6432  1.1     skrll #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
   6433  1.1     skrll #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
   6434  1.1     skrll #define MAP_STRTAB    (SHN_HIOS + 3)
   6435  1.1     skrll #define MAP_SHSTRTAB  (SHN_HIOS + 4)
   6436  1.1     skrll #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
   6437  1.1     skrll 
   6438  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   6439  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
   6440  1.1     skrll 				   asymbol *isymarg,
   6441  1.1     skrll 				   bfd *obfd,
   6442  1.1     skrll 				   asymbol *osymarg)
   6443  1.1     skrll {
   6444  1.1     skrll   elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
   6445  1.1     skrll 
   6446  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   6447  1.1     skrll       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   6448  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   6449  1.1     skrll 
   6450  1.1     skrll   isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
   6451  1.1     skrll   osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
   6452  1.1     skrll 
   6453  1.1     skrll   if (isym != NULL
   6454  1.1     skrll       && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
   6455  1.1     skrll       && osym != NULL
   6456  1.1     skrll       && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
   6457  1.1     skrll     {
   6458  1.1     skrll       unsigned int shndx;
   6459  1.1     skrll 
   6460  1.1     skrll       shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
   6461  1.1     skrll       if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
   6462  1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
   6463  1.1     skrll       else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
   6464  1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
   6465  1.1     skrll       else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->strtab_section)
   6466  1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
   6467  1.1     skrll       else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->shstrtab_section)
   6468  1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
   6469  1.1     skrll       else if (shndx == elf_tdata (ibfd)->symtab_shndx_section)
   6470  1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
   6471  1.1     skrll       osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
   6472  1.1     skrll     }
   6473  1.1     skrll 
   6474  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6475  1.1     skrll }
   6476  1.1     skrll 
   6477  1.1     skrll /* Swap out the symbols.  */
   6478  1.1     skrll 
   6479  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   6480  1.1     skrll swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
   6481  1.1     skrll 	       struct bfd_strtab_hash **sttp,
   6482  1.1     skrll 	       int relocatable_p)
   6483  1.1     skrll {
   6484  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   6485  1.1     skrll   int symcount;
   6486  1.1     skrll   asymbol **syms;
   6487  1.1     skrll   struct bfd_strtab_hash *stt;
   6488  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   6489  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
   6490  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
   6491  1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
   6492  1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
   6493  1.1     skrll   int idx;
   6494  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type amt;
   6495  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
   6496  1.1     skrll 
   6497  1.1     skrll   if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd))
   6498  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   6499  1.1     skrll 
   6500  1.1     skrll   /* Dump out the symtabs.  */
   6501  1.1     skrll   stt = _bfd_elf_stringtab_init ();
   6502  1.1     skrll   if (stt == NULL)
   6503  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   6504  1.1     skrll 
   6505  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   6506  1.1     skrll   symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
   6507  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   6508  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
   6509  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
   6510  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
   6511  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_info = elf_num_locals (abfd) + 1;
   6512  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
   6513  1.1     skrll 
   6514  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
   6515  1.3  christos   symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
   6516  1.3  christos 
   6517  1.1     skrll   outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
   6518  1.1     skrll                                            bed->s->sizeof_sym);
   6519  1.1     skrll   if (outbound_syms == NULL)
   6520  1.1     skrll     {
   6521  1.1     skrll       _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
   6522  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   6523  1.1     skrll     }
   6524  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
   6525  1.1     skrll 
   6526  1.1     skrll   outbound_shndx = NULL;
   6527  1.1     skrll   symtab_shndx_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_hdr;
   6528  1.1     skrll   if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
   6529  1.3  christos     {
   6530  1.3  christos       amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   6531  1.1     skrll       outbound_shndx =  (bfd_byte *)
   6532  1.1     skrll           bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
   6533  1.1     skrll       if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
   6534  1.1     skrll 	{
   6535  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
   6536  1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   6537  1.1     skrll 	}
   6538  1.1     skrll 
   6539  1.1     skrll       symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
   6540  1.1     skrll       symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
   6541  1.1     skrll       symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
   6542  1.1     skrll       symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   6543  1.1     skrll       symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   6544  1.1     skrll     }
   6545  1.1     skrll 
   6546  1.1     skrll   /* Now generate the data (for "contents").  */
   6547  1.1     skrll   {
   6548  1.1     skrll     /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out.  */
   6549  1.1     skrll     Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
   6550  1.1     skrll     sym.st_name = 0;
   6551  1.1     skrll     sym.st_value = 0;
   6552  1.1     skrll     sym.st_size = 0;
   6553  1.1     skrll     sym.st_info = 0;
   6554  1.1     skrll     sym.st_other = 0;
   6555  1.1     skrll     sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
   6556  1.1     skrll     bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &sym, outbound_syms, outbound_shndx);
   6557  1.1     skrll     outbound_syms += bed->s->sizeof_sym;
   6558  1.1     skrll     if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
   6559  1.1     skrll       outbound_shndx += sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   6560  1.1     skrll   }
   6561  1.1     skrll 
   6562  1.1     skrll   name_local_sections
   6563  1.1     skrll     = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
   6564  1.1     skrll        && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
   6565  1.1     skrll 
   6566  1.1     skrll   syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
   6567  1.1     skrll   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
   6568  1.1     skrll     {
   6569  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
   6570  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
   6571  1.1     skrll       elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
   6572  1.1     skrll       flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
   6573  1.1     skrll       int type;
   6574  1.1     skrll 
   6575  1.1     skrll       if (!name_local_sections
   6576  1.1     skrll 	  && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
   6577  1.1     skrll 	{
   6578  1.1     skrll 	  /* Local section symbols have no name.  */
   6579  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_name = 0;
   6580  1.1     skrll 	}
   6581  1.1     skrll       else
   6582  1.1     skrll 	{
   6583  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_name = (unsigned long) _bfd_stringtab_add (stt,
   6584  1.1     skrll 							    syms[idx]->name,
   6585  1.1     skrll 							    TRUE, FALSE);
   6586  1.1     skrll 	  if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
   6587  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6588  1.1     skrll 	      _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
   6589  1.1     skrll 	      return FALSE;
   6590  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6591  1.1     skrll 	}
   6592  1.1     skrll 
   6593  1.1     skrll       type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
   6594  1.1     skrll 
   6595  1.1     skrll       if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
   6596  1.1     skrll 	  && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
   6597  1.1     skrll 	{
   6598  1.1     skrll 	  /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
   6599  1.1     skrll 	     and the size into the `size' field.  This is backwards from
   6600  1.1     skrll 	     how BFD handles it, so reverse it here.  */
   6601  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_size = value;
   6602  1.1     skrll 	  if (type_ptr == NULL
   6603  1.1     skrll 	      || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
   6604  1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
   6605  1.1     skrll 	  else
   6606  1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
   6607  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
   6608  1.1     skrll 	    (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
   6609  1.1     skrll 	}
   6610  1.1     skrll       else
   6611  1.1     skrll 	{
   6612  1.1     skrll 	  asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
   6613  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int shndx;
   6614  1.1     skrll 
   6615  1.1     skrll 	  if (sec->output_section)
   6616  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6617  1.1     skrll 	      value += sec->output_offset;
   6618  1.1     skrll 	      sec = sec->output_section;
   6619  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6620  1.1     skrll 
   6621  1.1     skrll 	  /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output.  */
   6622  1.1     skrll 	  if (! relocatable_p)
   6623  1.1     skrll 	    value += sec->vma;
   6624  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_value = value;
   6625  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
   6626  1.1     skrll 
   6627  1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
   6628  1.1     skrll 	      && type_ptr != NULL
   6629  1.1     skrll 	      && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
   6630  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6631  1.1     skrll 	      /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
   6632  1.1     skrll 		 not create as a BFD section.  Undo the mapping done
   6633  1.1     skrll 		 by copy_private_symbol_data.  */
   6634  1.1     skrll 	      shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
   6635  1.1     skrll 	      switch (shndx)
   6636  1.1     skrll 		{
   6637  1.1     skrll 		case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
   6638  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   6639  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   6640  1.1     skrll 		case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
   6641  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
   6642  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   6643  1.1     skrll 		case MAP_STRTAB:
   6644  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_section;
   6645  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   6646  1.1     skrll 		case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
   6647  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_section;
   6648  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   6649  1.1     skrll 		case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
   6650  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_shndx_section;
   6651  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   6652  1.1     skrll 		default:
   6653  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   6654  1.1     skrll 		}
   6655  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6656  1.1     skrll 	  else
   6657  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6658  1.1     skrll 	      shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
   6659  1.1     skrll 
   6660  1.1     skrll 	      if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
   6661  1.1     skrll 		{
   6662  1.1     skrll 		  asection *sec2;
   6663  1.1     skrll 
   6664  1.1     skrll 		  /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
   6665  1.1     skrll 		     we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
   6666  1.1     skrll 		     knew what to expect of the library, and what to
   6667  1.1     skrll 		     demand of applications.  For example, it
   6668  1.1     skrll 		     appears that `objcopy' might not set the
   6669  1.1     skrll 		     section of a symbol to be a section that is
   6670  1.1     skrll 		     actually in the output file.  */
   6671  1.1     skrll 		  sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
   6672  1.1     skrll 		  if (sec2 == NULL)
   6673  1.1     skrll 		    {
   6674  1.1     skrll 		      _bfd_error_handler (_("\
   6675  1.1     skrll Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
   6676  1.1     skrll 					  syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
   6677  1.1     skrll 					  sec->name);
   6678  1.1     skrll 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   6679  1.1     skrll 		      _bfd_stringtab_free (stt);
   6680  1.1     skrll 		      return FALSE;
   6681  1.1     skrll 		    }
   6682  1.1     skrll 
   6683  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
   6684  1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT (shndx != SHN_BAD);
   6685  1.1     skrll 		}
   6686  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6687  1.1     skrll 
   6688  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_shndx = shndx;
   6689  1.1     skrll 	}
   6690  1.1     skrll 
   6691  1.3  christos       if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   6692  1.3  christos 	type = STT_TLS;
   6693  1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
   6694  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
   6695  1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
   6696  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_FUNC;
   6697  1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
   6698  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_OBJECT;
   6699  1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
   6700  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_RELC;
   6701  1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
   6702  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_SRELC;
   6703  1.1     skrll       else
   6704  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_NOTYPE;
   6705  1.1     skrll 
   6706  1.1     skrll       if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   6707  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_TLS;
   6708  1.1     skrll 
   6709  1.1     skrll       /* Processor-specific types.  */
   6710  1.1     skrll       if (type_ptr != NULL
   6711  1.1     skrll 	  && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
   6712  1.1     skrll 	type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
   6713  1.1     skrll 		(&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
   6714  1.1     skrll 
   6715  1.1     skrll       if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
   6716  1.1     skrll 	{
   6717  1.1     skrll 	  if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
   6718  1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
   6719  1.1     skrll 	  else
   6720  1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
   6721  1.1     skrll 	}
   6722  1.1     skrll       else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
   6723  1.1     skrll 	{
   6724  1.1     skrll #ifdef USE_STT_COMMON
   6725  1.1     skrll 	  if (type == STT_OBJECT)
   6726  1.3  christos 	    sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_COMMON);
   6727  1.1     skrll 	  else
   6728  1.1     skrll #endif
   6729  1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
   6730  1.1     skrll 	}
   6731  1.1     skrll       else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
   6732  1.1     skrll 	sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
   6733  1.1     skrll 				    ? STB_WEAK
   6734  1.1     skrll 				    : STB_GLOBAL),
   6735  1.1     skrll 				   type);
   6736  1.1     skrll       else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
   6737  1.1     skrll 	sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
   6738  1.1     skrll       else
   6739  1.1     skrll 	{
   6740  1.1     skrll 	  int bind = STB_LOCAL;
   6741  1.1     skrll 
   6742  1.3  christos 	  if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
   6743  1.3  christos 	    bind = STB_LOCAL;
   6744  1.1     skrll 	  else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
   6745  1.1     skrll 	    bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
   6746  1.1     skrll 	  else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
   6747  1.1     skrll 	    bind = STB_WEAK;
   6748  1.1     skrll 	  else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
   6749  1.1     skrll 	    bind = STB_GLOBAL;
   6750  1.1     skrll 
   6751  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
   6752  1.1     skrll 	}
   6753  1.1     skrll 
   6754  1.1     skrll       if (type_ptr != NULL)
   6755  1.1     skrll 	sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
   6756  1.1     skrll       else
   6757  1.1     skrll 	sym.st_other = 0;
   6758  1.1     skrll 
   6759  1.1     skrll       bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &sym, outbound_syms, outbound_shndx);
   6760  1.1     skrll       outbound_syms += bed->s->sizeof_sym;
   6761  1.1     skrll       if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
   6762  1.1     skrll 	outbound_shndx += sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   6763  1.1     skrll     }
   6764  1.1     skrll 
   6765  1.1     skrll   *sttp = stt;
   6766  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_stringtab_size (stt);
   6767  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
   6768  1.1     skrll 
   6769  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
   6770  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   6771  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   6772  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
   6773  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
   6774  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
   6775  1.1     skrll 
   6776  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6777  1.1     skrll }
   6778  1.1     skrll 
   6779  1.1     skrll /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
   6780  1.1     skrll 
   6781  1.1     skrll    Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
   6782  1.1     skrll    the vector allocated based on this size.  However, the ELF symbol table
   6783  1.1     skrll    always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even.  */
   6784  1.1     skrll 
   6785  1.1     skrll long
   6786  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   6787  1.1     skrll {
   6788  1.1     skrll   long symcount;
   6789  1.1     skrll   long symtab_size;
   6790  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   6791  1.1     skrll 
   6792  1.1     skrll   symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
   6793  1.1     skrll   symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
   6794  1.1     skrll   if (symcount > 0)
   6795  1.1     skrll     symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
   6796  1.1     skrll 
   6797  1.1     skrll   return symtab_size;
   6798  1.1     skrll }
   6799  1.1     skrll 
   6800  1.1     skrll long
   6801  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   6802  1.1     skrll {
   6803  1.1     skrll   long symcount;
   6804  1.1     skrll   long symtab_size;
   6805  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
   6806  1.1     skrll 
   6807  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   6808  1.1     skrll     {
   6809  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   6810  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   6811  1.1     skrll     }
   6812  1.1     skrll 
   6813  1.1     skrll   symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
   6814  1.1     skrll   symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
   6815  1.1     skrll   if (symcount > 0)
   6816  1.1     skrll     symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
   6817  1.1     skrll 
   6818  1.1     skrll   return symtab_size;
   6819  1.1     skrll }
   6820  1.1     skrll 
   6821  1.1     skrll long
   6822  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   6823  1.1     skrll 				sec_ptr asect)
   6824  1.1     skrll {
   6825  1.1     skrll   return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
   6826  1.1     skrll }
   6827  1.1     skrll 
   6828  1.1     skrll /* Canonicalize the relocs.  */
   6829  1.1     skrll 
   6830  1.1     skrll long
   6831  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
   6832  1.1     skrll 			     sec_ptr section,
   6833  1.1     skrll 			     arelent **relptr,
   6834  1.1     skrll 			     asymbol **symbols)
   6835  1.1     skrll {
   6836  1.1     skrll   arelent *tblptr;
   6837  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   6838  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   6839  1.1     skrll 
   6840  1.1     skrll   if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
   6841  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   6842  1.1     skrll 
   6843  1.1     skrll   tblptr = section->relocation;
   6844  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
   6845  1.1     skrll     *relptr++ = tblptr++;
   6846  1.1     skrll 
   6847  1.1     skrll   *relptr = NULL;
   6848  1.1     skrll 
   6849  1.1     skrll   return section->reloc_count;
   6850  1.1     skrll }
   6851  1.1     skrll 
   6852  1.1     skrll long
   6853  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
   6854  1.1     skrll {
   6855  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   6856  1.1     skrll   long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
   6857  1.1     skrll 
   6858  1.1     skrll   if (symcount >= 0)
   6859  1.1     skrll     bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
   6860  1.1     skrll   return symcount;
   6861  1.1     skrll }
   6862  1.1     skrll 
   6863  1.1     skrll long
   6864  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
   6865  1.1     skrll 				      asymbol **allocation)
   6866  1.1     skrll {
   6867  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   6868  1.1     skrll   long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
   6869  1.1     skrll 
   6870  1.1     skrll   if (symcount >= 0)
   6871  1.1     skrll     bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
   6872  1.1     skrll   return symcount;
   6873  1.1     skrll }
   6874  1.1     skrll 
   6875  1.1     skrll /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries.  Any loadable
   6876  1.1     skrll    section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
   6877  1.1     skrll    or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
   6878  1.1     skrll    dynamic reloc section.  */
   6879  1.1     skrll 
   6880  1.1     skrll long
   6881  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   6882  1.1     skrll {
   6883  1.1     skrll   long ret;
   6884  1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   6885  1.1     skrll 
   6886  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   6887  1.1     skrll     {
   6888  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   6889  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   6890  1.1     skrll     }
   6891  1.1     skrll 
   6892  1.1     skrll   ret = sizeof (arelent *);
   6893  1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   6894  1.1     skrll     if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
   6895  1.1     skrll 	&& (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
   6896  1.1     skrll 	    || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
   6897  1.1     skrll       ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
   6898  1.1     skrll 	      * sizeof (arelent *));
   6899  1.1     skrll 
   6900  1.1     skrll   return ret;
   6901  1.1     skrll }
   6902  1.1     skrll 
   6903  1.1     skrll /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries.  Note that we return the
   6904  1.1     skrll    dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
   6905  1.1     skrll    associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
   6906  1.1     skrll    designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
   6907  1.1     skrll    one set of dynamic relocs.  Any loadable section that was actually
   6908  1.1     skrll    installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
   6909  1.1     skrll    dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section.  */
   6910  1.1     skrll 
   6911  1.1     skrll long
   6912  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
   6913  1.1     skrll 				     arelent **storage,
   6914  1.1     skrll 				     asymbol **syms)
   6915  1.1     skrll {
   6916  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
   6917  1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   6918  1.1     skrll   long ret;
   6919  1.1     skrll 
   6920  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   6921  1.1     skrll     {
   6922  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   6923  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   6924  1.1     skrll     }
   6925  1.1     skrll 
   6926  1.1     skrll   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
   6927  1.1     skrll   ret = 0;
   6928  1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   6929  1.1     skrll     {
   6930  1.1     skrll       if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
   6931  1.1     skrll 	  && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
   6932  1.1     skrll 	      || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
   6933  1.1     skrll 	{
   6934  1.1     skrll 	  arelent *p;
   6935  1.1     skrll 	  long count, i;
   6936  1.1     skrll 
   6937  1.1     skrll 	  if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
   6938  1.1     skrll 	    return -1;
   6939  1.1     skrll 	  count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
   6940  1.1     skrll 	  p = s->relocation;
   6941  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
   6942  1.1     skrll 	    *storage++ = p++;
   6943  1.1     skrll 	  ret += count;
   6944  1.1     skrll 	}
   6945  1.1     skrll     }
   6946  1.1     skrll 
   6947  1.1     skrll   *storage = NULL;
   6948  1.1     skrll 
   6949  1.1     skrll   return ret;
   6950  1.1     skrll }
   6951  1.1     skrll 
   6952  1.1     skrll /* Read in the version information.  */
   6954  1.1     skrll 
   6955  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   6956  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
   6957  1.1     skrll {
   6958  1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
   6959  1.1     skrll   unsigned int freeidx = 0;
   6960  1.1     skrll 
   6961  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
   6962  1.1     skrll     {
   6963  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   6964  1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
   6965  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
   6966  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   6967  1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *contents_end;
   6968  1.3  christos 
   6969  1.3  christos       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
   6970  1.1     skrll 
   6971  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
   6972  1.1     skrll           bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
   6973  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
   6974  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   6975  1.3  christos 
   6976  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = hdr->sh_info;
   6977  1.1     skrll 
   6978  1.1     skrll       contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
   6979  1.1     skrll       if (contents == NULL)
   6980  1.1     skrll 	{
   6981  1.1     skrll error_return_verref:
   6982  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
   6983  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
   6984  1.1     skrll 	  goto error_return;
   6985  1.1     skrll 	}
   6986  1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   6987  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
   6988  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verref;
   6989  1.1     skrll 
   6990  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_info && hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
   6991  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verref;
   6992  1.1     skrll 
   6993  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
   6994  1.1     skrll 		  == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
   6995  1.1     skrll       contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
   6996  1.1     skrll       everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
   6997  1.1     skrll       iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
   6998  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
   6999  1.1     skrll 	{
   7000  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
   7001  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
   7002  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int j;
   7003  1.1     skrll 
   7004  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
   7005  1.1     skrll 
   7006  1.1     skrll 	  iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
   7007  1.1     skrll 
   7008  1.1     skrll 	  iverneed->vn_filename =
   7009  1.1     skrll 	    bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
   7010  1.1     skrll 					     iverneed->vn_file);
   7011  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
   7012  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_verref;
   7013  1.1     skrll 
   7014  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
   7015  1.3  christos 	    iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
   7016  1.3  christos 	  else
   7017  1.3  christos 	    {
   7018  1.1     skrll 	      iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
   7019  1.1     skrll                   bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
   7020  1.1     skrll                               sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
   7021  1.1     skrll 	      if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
   7022  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_verref;
   7023  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7024  1.1     skrll 
   7025  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_aux
   7026  1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
   7027  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_verref;
   7028  1.1     skrll 
   7029  1.1     skrll 	  evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
   7030  1.1     skrll 		      ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
   7031  1.1     skrll 	  ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
   7032  1.1     skrll 	  for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
   7033  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7034  1.1     skrll 	      _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
   7035  1.1     skrll 
   7036  1.1     skrll 	      ivernaux->vna_nodename =
   7037  1.1     skrll 		bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
   7038  1.1     skrll 						 ivernaux->vna_name);
   7039  1.1     skrll 	      if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
   7040  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_verref;
   7041  1.1     skrll 
   7042  1.1     skrll 	      if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
   7043  1.1     skrll 		ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
   7044  1.1     skrll 	      else
   7045  1.1     skrll 		ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
   7046  1.1     skrll 
   7047  1.1     skrll 	      if (ivernaux->vna_next
   7048  1.1     skrll 		  > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
   7049  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_verref;
   7050  1.1     skrll 
   7051  1.1     skrll 	      evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
   7052  1.1     skrll 			  ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
   7053  1.1     skrll 
   7054  1.1     skrll 	      if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
   7055  1.1     skrll 		freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
   7056  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7057  1.1     skrll 
   7058  1.1     skrll 	  if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
   7059  1.1     skrll 	    iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
   7060  1.1     skrll 	  else
   7061  1.1     skrll 	    iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
   7062  1.1     skrll 
   7063  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_next
   7064  1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
   7065  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_verref;
   7066  1.1     skrll 
   7067  1.1     skrll 	  everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
   7068  1.1     skrll 		      ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
   7069  1.1     skrll 	}
   7070  1.1     skrll 
   7071  1.1     skrll       free (contents);
   7072  1.1     skrll       contents = NULL;
   7073  1.1     skrll     }
   7074  1.1     skrll 
   7075  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
   7076  1.1     skrll     {
   7077  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   7078  1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
   7079  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
   7080  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
   7081  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
   7082  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   7083  1.1     skrll       unsigned int maxidx;
   7084  1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
   7085  1.3  christos 
   7086  1.1     skrll       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
   7087  1.1     skrll 
   7088  1.1     skrll       contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
   7089  1.1     skrll       if (contents == NULL)
   7090  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   7091  1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   7092  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
   7093  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   7094  1.1     skrll 
   7095  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_info && hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
   7096  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   7097  1.1     skrll 
   7098  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
   7099  1.1     skrll 		  >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
   7100  1.1     skrll       contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
   7101  1.1     skrll 			 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
   7102  1.1     skrll       contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
   7103  1.1     skrll 			 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
   7104  1.1     skrll 
   7105  1.1     skrll       /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
   7106  1.1     skrll 	 index.  Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
   7107  1.1     skrll 	 the maximum.  */
   7108  1.1     skrll       everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
   7109  1.1     skrll       maxidx = 0;
   7110  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
   7111  1.1     skrll 	{
   7112  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
   7113  1.1     skrll 
   7114  1.1     skrll 	  if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
   7115  1.1     skrll 	    maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
   7116  1.1     skrll 
   7117  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdefmem.vd_next
   7118  1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
   7119  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   7120  1.1     skrll 
   7121  1.1     skrll 	  everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
   7122  1.1     skrll 		     ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
   7123  1.1     skrll 	}
   7124  1.1     skrll 
   7125  1.1     skrll       if (default_imported_symver)
   7126  1.1     skrll 	{
   7127  1.1     skrll 	  if (freeidx > maxidx)
   7128  1.1     skrll 	    maxidx = ++freeidx;
   7129  1.3  christos 	  else
   7130  1.3  christos 	    freeidx = ++maxidx;
   7131  1.1     skrll 	}
   7132  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
   7133  1.1     skrll           bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
   7134  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
   7135  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   7136  1.1     skrll 
   7137  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
   7138  1.1     skrll 
   7139  1.1     skrll       everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
   7140  1.1     skrll       iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
   7141  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
   7142  1.1     skrll 	{
   7143  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
   7144  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
   7145  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int j;
   7146  1.1     skrll 
   7147  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
   7148  1.1     skrll 
   7149  1.1     skrll 	  if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
   7150  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7151  1.1     skrll error_return_verdef:
   7152  1.1     skrll 	      elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
   7153  1.1     skrll 	      elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
   7154  1.1     skrll 	      goto error_return;
   7155  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7156  1.1     skrll 
   7157  1.1     skrll 	  iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
   7158  1.1     skrll 	  memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
   7159  1.1     skrll 
   7160  1.1     skrll 	  iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
   7161  1.1     skrll 
   7162  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
   7163  1.3  christos 	    iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
   7164  1.3  christos 	  else
   7165  1.3  christos 	    {
   7166  1.1     skrll 	      iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
   7167  1.1     skrll                   bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
   7168  1.1     skrll                               sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
   7169  1.1     skrll 	      if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
   7170  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_verdef;
   7171  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7172  1.1     skrll 
   7173  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdef->vd_aux
   7174  1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
   7175  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_verdef;
   7176  1.1     skrll 
   7177  1.1     skrll 	  everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
   7178  1.1     skrll 		      ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
   7179  1.1     skrll 	  iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
   7180  1.1     skrll 	  for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
   7181  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7182  1.1     skrll 	      _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
   7183  1.1     skrll 
   7184  1.1     skrll 	      iverdaux->vda_nodename =
   7185  1.1     skrll 		bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
   7186  1.1     skrll 						 iverdaux->vda_name);
   7187  1.1     skrll 	      if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
   7188  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_verdef;
   7189  1.1     skrll 
   7190  1.1     skrll 	      if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
   7191  1.1     skrll 		iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
   7192  1.1     skrll 	      else
   7193  1.1     skrll 		iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
   7194  1.1     skrll 
   7195  1.1     skrll 	      if (iverdaux->vda_next
   7196  1.1     skrll 		  > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
   7197  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_verdef;
   7198  1.1     skrll 
   7199  1.1     skrll 	      everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
   7200  1.1     skrll 			  ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
   7201  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7202  1.1     skrll 
   7203  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
   7204  1.1     skrll 	    iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
   7205  1.1     skrll 
   7206  1.1     skrll 	  if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
   7207  1.1     skrll 	    iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
   7208  1.1     skrll 	  else
   7209  1.1     skrll 	    iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
   7210  1.1     skrll 
   7211  1.1     skrll 	  everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
   7212  1.1     skrll 		     ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
   7213  1.1     skrll 	}
   7214  1.1     skrll 
   7215  1.1     skrll       free (contents);
   7216  1.1     skrll       contents = NULL;
   7217  1.1     skrll     }
   7218  1.1     skrll   else if (default_imported_symver)
   7219  1.1     skrll     {
   7220  1.1     skrll       if (freeidx < 3)
   7221  1.1     skrll 	freeidx = 3;
   7222  1.3  christos       else
   7223  1.3  christos 	freeidx++;
   7224  1.1     skrll 
   7225  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
   7226  1.1     skrll           bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
   7227  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
   7228  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   7229  1.1     skrll 
   7230  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
   7231  1.1     skrll     }
   7232  1.1     skrll 
   7233  1.1     skrll   /* Create a default version based on the soname.  */
   7234  1.1     skrll   if (default_imported_symver)
   7235  1.1     skrll     {
   7236  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
   7237  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
   7238  1.1     skrll 
   7239  1.1     skrll       iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];;
   7240  1.1     skrll 
   7241  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
   7242  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
   7243  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
   7244  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
   7245  1.1     skrll 
   7246  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
   7247  1.1     skrll 
   7248  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
   7249  1.3  christos       if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
   7250  1.3  christos 	goto error_return_verdef;
   7251  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
   7252  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
   7253  1.1     skrll           bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
   7254  1.1     skrll       if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
   7255  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verdef;
   7256  1.1     skrll 
   7257  1.1     skrll       iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
   7258  1.1     skrll       iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
   7259  1.1     skrll       iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
   7260  1.1     skrll     }
   7261  1.1     skrll 
   7262  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7263  1.1     skrll 
   7264  1.1     skrll  error_return:
   7265  1.1     skrll   if (contents != NULL)
   7266  1.1     skrll     free (contents);
   7267  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   7268  1.1     skrll }
   7269  1.1     skrll 
   7270  1.1     skrll asymbol *
   7272  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
   7273  1.3  christos {
   7274  1.1     skrll   elf_symbol_type *newsym;
   7275  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (elf_symbol_type);
   7276  1.1     skrll 
   7277  1.1     skrll   newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   7278  1.1     skrll   if (!newsym)
   7279  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   7280  1.1     skrll   else
   7281  1.1     skrll     {
   7282  1.1     skrll       newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
   7283  1.1     skrll       return &newsym->symbol;
   7284  1.1     skrll     }
   7285  1.1     skrll }
   7286  1.1     skrll 
   7287  1.1     skrll void
   7288  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   7289  1.1     skrll 			  asymbol *symbol,
   7290  1.1     skrll 			  symbol_info *ret)
   7291  1.1     skrll {
   7292  1.1     skrll   bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
   7293  1.1     skrll }
   7294  1.1     skrll 
   7295  1.1     skrll /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol.  Most targets
   7296  1.1     skrll    use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
   7297  1.1     skrll    override it.  */
   7298  1.1     skrll 
   7299  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7300  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   7301  1.1     skrll 			      const char *name)
   7302  1.1     skrll {
   7303  1.1     skrll   /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''.  */
   7304  1.1     skrll   if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
   7305  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7306  1.1     skrll 
   7307  1.1     skrll   /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
   7308  1.1     skrll      DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''.  */
   7309  1.1     skrll   if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
   7310  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7311  1.1     skrll 
   7312  1.1     skrll   /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
   7313  1.1     skrll      emitting DWARF debugging output.  I suspect this is actually a
   7314  1.1     skrll      small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
   7315  1.1     skrll      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
   7316  1.1     skrll      underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets).  For ease of use,
   7317  1.1     skrll      we treat such symbols as local.  */
   7318  1.1     skrll   if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
   7319  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7320  1.1     skrll 
   7321  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   7322  1.1     skrll }
   7323  1.1     skrll 
   7324  1.1     skrll alent *
   7325  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   7326  1.1     skrll 		     asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   7327  1.1     skrll {
   7328  1.1     skrll   abort ();
   7329  1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   7330  1.1     skrll }
   7331  1.1     skrll 
   7332  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7333  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
   7334  1.1     skrll 			enum bfd_architecture arch,
   7335  1.1     skrll 			unsigned long machine)
   7336  1.1     skrll {
   7337  1.1     skrll   /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
   7338  1.1     skrll      isn't the generic backend, fail.  */
   7339  1.1     skrll   if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
   7340  1.1     skrll       && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
   7341  1.1     skrll       && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
   7342  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7343  1.1     skrll 
   7344  1.1     skrll   return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
   7345  1.1     skrll }
   7346  1.1     skrll 
   7347  1.3  christos /* Find the function to a particular section and offset,
   7348  1.1     skrll    for error reporting.  */
   7349  1.1     skrll 
   7350  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   7351  1.1     skrll elf_find_function (bfd *abfd,
   7352  1.1     skrll 		   asection *section,
   7353  1.1     skrll 		   asymbol **symbols,
   7354  1.1     skrll 		   bfd_vma offset,
   7355  1.1     skrll 		   const char **filename_ptr,
   7356  1.1     skrll 		   const char **functionname_ptr)
   7357  1.1     skrll {
   7358  1.1     skrll   const char *filename;
   7359  1.1     skrll   asymbol *func, *file;
   7360  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma low_func;
   7361  1.1     skrll   asymbol **p;
   7362  1.1     skrll   /* ??? Given multiple file symbols, it is impossible to reliably
   7363  1.1     skrll      choose the right file name for global symbols.  File symbols are
   7364  1.1     skrll      local symbols, and thus all file symbols must sort before any
   7365  1.1     skrll      global symbols.  The ELF spec may be interpreted to say that a
   7366  1.1     skrll      file symbol must sort before other local symbols, but currently
   7367  1.3  christos      ld -r doesn't do this.  So, for ld -r output, it is possible to
   7368  1.1     skrll      make a better choice of file name for local symbols by ignoring
   7369  1.1     skrll      file symbols appearing after a given local symbol.  */
   7370  1.1     skrll   enum { nothing_seen, symbol_seen, file_after_symbol_seen } state;
   7371  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   7372  1.1     skrll 
   7373  1.1     skrll   filename = NULL;
   7374  1.1     skrll   func = NULL;
   7375  1.1     skrll   file = NULL;
   7376  1.1     skrll   low_func = 0;
   7377  1.1     skrll   state = nothing_seen;
   7378  1.3  christos 
   7379  1.1     skrll   for (p = symbols; *p != NULL; p++)
   7380  1.1     skrll     {
   7381  1.1     skrll       elf_symbol_type *q;
   7382  1.3  christos       unsigned int type;
   7383  1.3  christos 
   7384  1.1     skrll       q = (elf_symbol_type *) *p;
   7385  1.1     skrll 
   7386  1.1     skrll       type = ELF_ST_TYPE (q->internal_elf_sym.st_info);
   7387  1.1     skrll       switch (type)
   7388  1.1     skrll 	{
   7389  1.1     skrll 	case STT_FILE:
   7390  1.3  christos 	  file = &q->symbol;
   7391  1.3  christos 	  if (state == symbol_seen)
   7392  1.3  christos 	    state = file_after_symbol_seen;
   7393  1.1     skrll 	  continue;
   7394  1.1     skrll 	default:
   7395  1.1     skrll 	  if (!bed->is_function_type (type))
   7396  1.1     skrll 	    break;
   7397  1.1     skrll 	case STT_NOTYPE:
   7398  1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_get_section (&q->symbol) == section
   7399  1.1     skrll 	      && q->symbol.value >= low_func
   7400  1.1     skrll 	      && q->symbol.value <= offset)
   7401  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7402  1.1     skrll 	      func = (asymbol *) q;
   7403  1.1     skrll 	      low_func = q->symbol.value;
   7404  1.1     skrll 	      filename = NULL;
   7405  1.1     skrll 	      if (file != NULL
   7406  1.1     skrll 		  && (ELF_ST_BIND (q->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STB_LOCAL
   7407  1.1     skrll 		      || state != file_after_symbol_seen))
   7408  1.1     skrll 		filename = bfd_asymbol_name (file);
   7409  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7410  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   7411  1.1     skrll 	}
   7412  1.1     skrll       if (state == nothing_seen)
   7413  1.1     skrll 	state = symbol_seen;
   7414  1.1     skrll     }
   7415  1.1     skrll 
   7416  1.1     skrll   if (func == NULL)
   7417  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7418  1.1     skrll 
   7419  1.1     skrll   if (filename_ptr)
   7420  1.1     skrll     *filename_ptr = filename;
   7421  1.1     skrll   if (functionname_ptr)
   7422  1.1     skrll     *functionname_ptr = bfd_asymbol_name (func);
   7423  1.1     skrll 
   7424  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7425  1.1     skrll }
   7426  1.1     skrll 
   7427  1.1     skrll /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
   7428  1.1     skrll    for error reporting.  */
   7429  1.1     skrll 
   7430  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7431  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
   7432  1.1     skrll 			    asection *section,
   7433  1.1     skrll 			    asymbol **symbols,
   7434  1.1     skrll 			    bfd_vma offset,
   7435  1.1     skrll 			    const char **filename_ptr,
   7436  1.1     skrll 			    const char **functionname_ptr,
   7437  1.1     skrll 			    unsigned int *line_ptr)
   7438  1.1     skrll {
   7439  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean found;
   7440  1.1     skrll 
   7441  1.1     skrll   if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
   7442  1.1     skrll 				     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
   7443  1.1     skrll 				     line_ptr))
   7444  1.1     skrll     {
   7445  1.1     skrll       if (!*functionname_ptr)
   7446  1.1     skrll 	elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
   7447  1.1     skrll 			   *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
   7448  1.1     skrll 			   functionname_ptr);
   7449  1.1     skrll 
   7450  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   7451  1.1     skrll     }
   7452  1.1     skrll 
   7453  1.1     skrll   if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
   7454  1.1     skrll 				     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
   7455  1.1     skrll 				     line_ptr, 0,
   7456  1.1     skrll 				     &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
   7457  1.1     skrll     {
   7458  1.1     skrll       if (!*functionname_ptr)
   7459  1.1     skrll 	elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
   7460  1.1     skrll 			   *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
   7461  1.1     skrll 			   functionname_ptr);
   7462  1.1     skrll 
   7463  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   7464  1.1     skrll     }
   7465  1.1     skrll 
   7466  1.1     skrll   if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
   7467  1.1     skrll 					     &found, filename_ptr,
   7468  1.1     skrll 					     functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
   7469  1.1     skrll 					     &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
   7470  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7471  1.1     skrll   if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
   7472  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7473  1.1     skrll 
   7474  1.1     skrll   if (symbols == NULL)
   7475  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7476  1.1     skrll 
   7477  1.1     skrll   if (! elf_find_function (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
   7478  1.1     skrll 			   filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
   7479  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7480  1.1     skrll 
   7481  1.1     skrll   *line_ptr = 0;
   7482  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7483  1.1     skrll }
   7484  1.1     skrll 
   7485  1.1     skrll /* Find the line for a symbol.  */
   7486  1.1     skrll 
   7487  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7488  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
   7489  1.1     skrll 		    const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
   7490  1.1     skrll {
   7491  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_dwarf2_find_line (abfd, symbols, symbol,
   7492  1.1     skrll 				filename_ptr, line_ptr, 0,
   7493  1.1     skrll 				&elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
   7494  1.1     skrll }
   7495  1.1     skrll 
   7496  1.1     skrll /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
   7497  1.1     skrll    bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
   7498  1.1     skrll    each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
   7499  1.1     skrll    passed to bfd_find_nearest_line.  Currently this is only supported
   7500  1.1     skrll    for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
   7501  1.1     skrll 
   7502  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7503  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
   7504  1.1     skrll 			    const char **filename_ptr,
   7505  1.1     skrll 			    const char **functionname_ptr,
   7506  1.1     skrll 			    unsigned int *line_ptr)
   7507  1.1     skrll {
   7508  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean found;
   7509  1.1     skrll   found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
   7510  1.1     skrll 					 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
   7511  1.1     skrll 					 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
   7512  1.1     skrll   return found;
   7513  1.1     skrll }
   7514  1.1     skrll 
   7515  1.1     skrll int
   7516  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   7517  1.1     skrll {
   7518  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   7519  1.1     skrll   int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   7520  1.1     skrll 
   7521  1.1     skrll   if (!info->relocatable)
   7522  1.1     skrll     {
   7523  1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size;
   7524  1.1     skrll 
   7525  1.1     skrll       if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
   7526  1.1     skrll 	{
   7527  1.1     skrll 	  struct elf_segment_map *m;
   7528  1.1     skrll 
   7529  1.1     skrll 	  phdr_size = 0;
   7530  1.1     skrll 	  for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
   7531  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   7532  1.1     skrll 
   7533  1.1     skrll 	  if (phdr_size == 0)
   7534  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
   7535  1.1     skrll 	}
   7536  1.1     skrll 
   7537  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->program_header_size = phdr_size;
   7538  1.1     skrll       ret += phdr_size;
   7539  1.1     skrll     }
   7540  1.1     skrll 
   7541  1.1     skrll   return ret;
   7542  1.1     skrll }
   7543  1.1     skrll 
   7544  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7545  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
   7546  1.1     skrll 			       sec_ptr section,
   7547  1.1     skrll 			       const void *location,
   7548  1.1     skrll 			       file_ptr offset,
   7549  1.1     skrll 			       bfd_size_type count)
   7550  1.1     skrll {
   7551  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   7552  1.1     skrll   bfd_signed_vma pos;
   7553  1.1     skrll 
   7554  1.1     skrll   if (! abfd->output_has_begun
   7555  1.1     skrll       && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
   7556  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7557  1.1     skrll 
   7558  1.1     skrll   hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
   7559  1.1     skrll   pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
   7560  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
   7561  1.1     skrll       || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
   7562  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7563  1.1     skrll 
   7564  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7565  1.1     skrll }
   7566  1.1     skrll 
   7567  1.1     skrll void
   7568  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   7569  1.1     skrll 			   arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   7570  1.1     skrll 			   Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   7571  1.1     skrll {
   7572  1.1     skrll   abort ();
   7573  1.1     skrll }
   7574  1.1     skrll 
   7575  1.1     skrll /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one.  */
   7576  1.1     skrll 
   7577  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7578  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
   7579  1.1     skrll {
   7580  1.1     skrll   /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto.  */
   7581  1.1     skrll 
   7582  1.1     skrll   if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
   7583  1.1     skrll     {
   7584  1.1     skrll       bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
   7585  1.1     skrll       reloc_howto_type *howto;
   7586  1.1     skrll 
   7587  1.1     skrll       /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
   7588  1.1     skrll 	 equivalent ELF reloc.  */
   7589  1.1     skrll 
   7590  1.1     skrll       if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
   7591  1.1     skrll 	{
   7592  1.1     skrll 	  switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
   7593  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7594  1.1     skrll 	    case 8:
   7595  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
   7596  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7597  1.1     skrll 	    case 12:
   7598  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
   7599  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7600  1.1     skrll 	    case 16:
   7601  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
   7602  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7603  1.1     skrll 	    case 24:
   7604  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
   7605  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7606  1.1     skrll 	    case 32:
   7607  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
   7608  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7609  1.1     skrll 	    case 64:
   7610  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
   7611  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7612  1.1     skrll 	    default:
   7613  1.1     skrll 	      goto fail;
   7614  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7615  1.1     skrll 
   7616  1.1     skrll 	  howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
   7617  1.1     skrll 
   7618  1.1     skrll 	  if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
   7619  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7620  1.1     skrll 	      if (howto->pcrel_offset)
   7621  1.1     skrll 		areloc->addend += areloc->address;
   7622  1.1     skrll 	      else
   7623  1.1     skrll 		areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
   7624  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7625  1.1     skrll 	}
   7626  1.1     skrll       else
   7627  1.1     skrll 	{
   7628  1.1     skrll 	  switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
   7629  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7630  1.1     skrll 	    case 8:
   7631  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_8;
   7632  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7633  1.1     skrll 	    case 14:
   7634  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_14;
   7635  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7636  1.1     skrll 	    case 16:
   7637  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_16;
   7638  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7639  1.1     skrll 	    case 26:
   7640  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_26;
   7641  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7642  1.1     skrll 	    case 32:
   7643  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_32;
   7644  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7645  1.1     skrll 	    case 64:
   7646  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_64;
   7647  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   7648  1.1     skrll 	    default:
   7649  1.1     skrll 	      goto fail;
   7650  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7651  1.1     skrll 
   7652  1.1     skrll 	  howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
   7653  1.1     skrll 	}
   7654  1.1     skrll 
   7655  1.1     skrll       if (howto)
   7656  1.1     skrll 	areloc->howto = howto;
   7657  1.1     skrll       else
   7658  1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   7659  1.1     skrll     }
   7660  1.1     skrll 
   7661  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7662  1.1     skrll 
   7663  1.1     skrll  fail:
   7664  1.1     skrll   (*_bfd_error_handler)
   7665  1.1     skrll     (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
   7666  1.1     skrll      abfd, areloc->howto->name);
   7667  1.1     skrll   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   7668  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   7669  1.1     skrll }
   7670  1.1     skrll 
   7671  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7672  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
   7673  1.1     skrll {
   7674  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object)
   7675  1.1     skrll     {
   7676  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd) != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
   7677  1.1     skrll 	_bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   7678  1.1     skrll       _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd);
   7679  1.1     skrll     }
   7680  1.1     skrll 
   7681  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
   7682  1.1     skrll }
   7683  1.1     skrll 
   7684  1.1     skrll /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
   7685  1.1     skrll    in the relocation's offset.  Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
   7686  1.1     skrll    range-checking to interfere.  There is nothing else to do in processing
   7687  1.1     skrll    this reloc.  */
   7688  1.1     skrll 
   7689  1.1     skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
   7690  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
   7691  1.1     skrll   (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   7692  1.1     skrll    struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   7693  1.1     skrll    void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   7694  1.1     skrll    bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   7695  1.1     skrll {
   7696  1.1     skrll   return bfd_reloc_ok;
   7697  1.1     skrll }
   7698  1.1     skrll 
   7699  1.1     skrll /* Elf core file support.  Much of this only works on native
   7701  1.3  christos    toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
   7702  1.3  christos    machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
   7703  1.1     skrll    out details about the corefile.  */
   7704  1.1     skrll 
   7705  1.1     skrll #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
   7706  1.3  christos /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris.  */
   7707  1.3  christos # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
   7708  1.1     skrll # include <sys/procfs.h>
   7709  1.1     skrll #endif
   7710  1.1     skrll 
   7711  1.1     skrll /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
   7712  1.3  christos    PID of the main process for non-threaded cores.  */
   7713  1.3  christos 
   7714  1.3  christos static int
   7715  1.3  christos elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
   7716  1.3  christos {
   7717  1.3  christos   int pid;
   7718  1.3  christos 
   7719  1.1     skrll   pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid;
   7720  1.1     skrll   if (pid == 0)
   7721  1.1     skrll     pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid;
   7722  1.1     skrll 
   7723  1.1     skrll   return pid;
   7724  1.1     skrll }
   7725  1.1     skrll 
   7726  1.1     skrll /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
   7727  1.1     skrll    data from SECT.  Note, this function will generate a
   7728  1.1     skrll    reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
   7729  1.1     skrll    overwrite it.  */
   7730  1.1     skrll 
   7731  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   7732  1.1     skrll elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
   7733  1.1     skrll {
   7734  1.1     skrll   asection *sect2;
   7735  1.1     skrll 
   7736  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
   7737  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7738  1.1     skrll 
   7739  1.1     skrll   sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
   7740  1.1     skrll   if (sect2 == NULL)
   7741  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7742  1.1     skrll 
   7743  1.1     skrll   sect2->size = sect->size;
   7744  1.1     skrll   sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
   7745  1.1     skrll   sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
   7746  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7747  1.1     skrll }
   7748  1.1     skrll 
   7749  1.1     skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS.  This
   7750  1.1     skrll    actually creates up to two pseudosections:
   7751  1.1     skrll    - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
   7752  1.1     skrll      such a section already exists.
   7753  1.1     skrll    - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
   7754  1.1     skrll      PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
   7755  1.1     skrll    Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
   7756  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7757  1.1     skrll _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
   7758  1.1     skrll 				 char *name,
   7759  1.1     skrll 				 size_t size,
   7760  1.1     skrll 				 ufile_ptr filepos)
   7761  1.1     skrll {
   7762  1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   7763  1.1     skrll   char *threaded_name;
   7764  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   7765  1.1     skrll   asection *sect;
   7766  1.3  christos 
   7767  1.1     skrll   /* Build the section name.  */
   7768  1.1     skrll 
   7769  1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
   7770  1.1     skrll   len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   7771  1.1     skrll   threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   7772  1.1     skrll   if (threaded_name == NULL)
   7773  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7774  1.1     skrll   memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
   7775  1.1     skrll 
   7776  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
   7777  1.1     skrll 					     SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   7778  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   7779  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7780  1.1     skrll   sect->size = size;
   7781  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = filepos;
   7782  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   7783  1.1     skrll 
   7784  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
   7785  1.1     skrll }
   7786  1.1     skrll 
   7787  1.1     skrll /* prstatus_t exists on:
   7788  1.1     skrll      solaris 2.5+
   7789  1.1     skrll      linux 2.[01] + glibc
   7790  1.1     skrll      unixware 4.2
   7791  1.1     skrll */
   7792  1.1     skrll 
   7793  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
   7794  1.1     skrll 
   7795  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   7796  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7797  1.1     skrll {
   7798  1.1     skrll   size_t size;
   7799  1.1     skrll   int offset;
   7800  1.1     skrll 
   7801  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
   7802  1.1     skrll     {
   7803  1.1     skrll       prstatus_t prstat;
   7804  1.1     skrll 
   7805  1.1     skrll       size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
   7806  1.1     skrll       offset   = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
   7807  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
   7808  1.3  christos 
   7809  1.3  christos       /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
   7810  1.1     skrll 	 has already been set by another thread.  */
   7811  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
   7812  1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
   7813  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid == 0)
   7814  1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = prstat.pr_pid;
   7815  1.1     skrll 
   7816  1.1     skrll       /* pr_who exists on:
   7817  1.1     skrll 	 solaris 2.5+
   7818  1.1     skrll 	 unixware 4.2
   7819  1.3  christos 	 pr_who doesn't exist on:
   7820  1.3  christos 	 linux 2.[01]
   7821  1.1     skrll 	 */
   7822  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
   7823  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
   7824  1.1     skrll #else
   7825  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
   7826  1.1     skrll #endif
   7827  1.1     skrll     }
   7828  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
   7829  1.1     skrll   else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
   7830  1.1     skrll     {
   7831  1.1     skrll       /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
   7832  1.1     skrll       prstatus32_t prstat;
   7833  1.1     skrll 
   7834  1.1     skrll       size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
   7835  1.1     skrll       offset   = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
   7836  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
   7837  1.3  christos 
   7838  1.3  christos       /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
   7839  1.1     skrll 	 has already been set by another thread.  */
   7840  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
   7841  1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
   7842  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid == 0)
   7843  1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = prstat.pr_pid;
   7844  1.1     skrll 
   7845  1.1     skrll       /* pr_who exists on:
   7846  1.1     skrll 	 solaris 2.5+
   7847  1.1     skrll 	 unixware 4.2
   7848  1.3  christos 	 pr_who doesn't exist on:
   7849  1.3  christos 	 linux 2.[01]
   7850  1.1     skrll 	 */
   7851  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
   7852  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
   7853  1.1     skrll #else
   7854  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
   7855  1.1     skrll #endif
   7856  1.1     skrll     }
   7857  1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
   7858  1.1     skrll   else
   7859  1.1     skrll     {
   7860  1.1     skrll       /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
   7861  1.1     skrll 	 note size (ie. data object type).  */
   7862  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   7863  1.1     skrll     }
   7864  1.1     skrll 
   7865  1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section.  */
   7866  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
   7867  1.1     skrll 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
   7868  1.1     skrll }
   7869  1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
   7870  1.1     skrll 
   7871  1.1     skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE.  */
   7872  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   7873  1.1     skrll elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
   7874  1.1     skrll 				 char *name,
   7875  1.1     skrll 				 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7876  1.1     skrll {
   7877  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
   7878  1.1     skrll 					  note->descsz, note->descpos);
   7879  1.1     skrll }
   7880  1.1     skrll 
   7881  1.1     skrll /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
   7882  1.1     skrll    but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
   7883  1.1     skrll    data structure apart.  */
   7884  1.1     skrll 
   7885  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   7886  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7887  1.1     skrll {
   7888  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   7889  1.1     skrll }
   7890  1.1     skrll 
   7891  1.1     skrll /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
   7892  1.1     skrll    type of NT_PRXFPREG.  Just include the whole note's contents
   7893  1.1     skrll    literally.  */
   7894  1.1     skrll 
   7895  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   7896  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7897  1.3  christos {
   7898  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
   7899  1.3  christos }
   7900  1.3  christos 
   7901  1.3  christos /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
   7902  1.3  christos    with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE.  Just include the whole note's
   7903  1.3  christos    contents literally.  */
   7904  1.3  christos 
   7905  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   7906  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7907  1.1     skrll {
   7908  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
   7909  1.1     skrll }
   7910  1.1     skrll 
   7911  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   7912  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7913  1.1     skrll {
   7914  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
   7915  1.1     skrll }
   7916  1.1     skrll 
   7917  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   7918  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7919  1.3  christos {
   7920  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
   7921  1.3  christos }
   7922  1.3  christos 
   7923  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   7924  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7925  1.3  christos {
   7926  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
   7927  1.3  christos }
   7928  1.3  christos 
   7929  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   7930  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7931  1.3  christos {
   7932  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
   7933  1.3  christos }
   7934  1.3  christos 
   7935  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   7936  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7937  1.3  christos {
   7938  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
   7939  1.3  christos }
   7940  1.3  christos 
   7941  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   7942  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7943  1.3  christos {
   7944  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
   7945  1.3  christos }
   7946  1.3  christos 
   7947  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   7948  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7949  1.3  christos {
   7950  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
   7951  1.3  christos }
   7952  1.3  christos 
   7953  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   7954  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   7955  1.1     skrll {
   7956  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
   7957  1.1     skrll }
   7958  1.1     skrll 
   7959  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
   7960  1.1     skrll typedef prpsinfo_t   elfcore_psinfo_t;
   7961  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T)		/* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
   7962  1.1     skrll typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
   7963  1.1     skrll #endif
   7964  1.1     skrll #endif
   7965  1.1     skrll 
   7966  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   7967  1.1     skrll typedef psinfo_t   elfcore_psinfo_t;
   7968  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)		/* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
   7969  1.1     skrll typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
   7970  1.1     skrll #endif
   7971  1.1     skrll #endif
   7972  1.1     skrll 
   7973  1.1     skrll /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
   7974  1.1     skrll    most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
   7975  1.1     skrll    the copy will always have a terminating '\0'.  */
   7976  1.3  christos 
   7977  1.1     skrll char *
   7978  1.1     skrll _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
   7979  1.1     skrll {
   7980  1.1     skrll   char *dups;
   7981  1.1     skrll   char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
   7982  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   7983  1.1     skrll 
   7984  1.3  christos   if (end == NULL)
   7985  1.1     skrll     len = max;
   7986  1.1     skrll   else
   7987  1.1     skrll     len = end - start;
   7988  1.1     skrll 
   7989  1.1     skrll   dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
   7990  1.1     skrll   if (dups == NULL)
   7991  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   7992  1.1     skrll 
   7993  1.1     skrll   memcpy (dups, start, len);
   7994  1.1     skrll   dups[len] = '\0';
   7995  1.1     skrll 
   7996  1.1     skrll   return dups;
   7997  1.1     skrll }
   7998  1.1     skrll 
   7999  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   8000  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8001  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8002  1.1     skrll {
   8003  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
   8004  1.3  christos     {
   8005  1.3  christos       elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
   8006  1.3  christos 
   8007  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
   8008  1.1     skrll 
   8009  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
   8010  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
   8011  1.1     skrll #endif
   8012  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
   8013  1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
   8014  1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
   8015  1.1     skrll 
   8016  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
   8017  1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
   8018  1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
   8019  1.1     skrll     }
   8020  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
   8021  1.1     skrll   else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
   8022  1.1     skrll     {
   8023  1.3  christos       /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
   8024  1.3  christos       elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
   8025  1.3  christos 
   8026  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
   8027  1.1     skrll 
   8028  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
   8029  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
   8030  1.1     skrll #endif
   8031  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
   8032  1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
   8033  1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
   8034  1.1     skrll 
   8035  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
   8036  1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
   8037  1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
   8038  1.1     skrll     }
   8039  1.1     skrll #endif
   8040  1.1     skrll 
   8041  1.1     skrll   else
   8042  1.1     skrll     {
   8043  1.1     skrll       /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
   8044  1.1     skrll 	 note size (ie. data object type).  */
   8045  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8046  1.1     skrll     }
   8047  1.1     skrll 
   8048  1.1     skrll   /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
   8049  1.1     skrll      onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
   8050  1.1     skrll      implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
   8051  1.1     skrll 
   8052  1.1     skrll   {
   8053  1.1     skrll     char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command;
   8054  1.1     skrll     int n = strlen (command);
   8055  1.1     skrll 
   8056  1.1     skrll     if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
   8057  1.1     skrll       command[n - 1] = '\0';
   8058  1.1     skrll   }
   8059  1.1     skrll 
   8060  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8061  1.1     skrll }
   8062  1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
   8063  1.1     skrll 
   8064  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
   8065  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8066  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8067  1.1     skrll {
   8068  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
   8069  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
   8070  1.1     skrll       || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
   8071  1.1     skrll #endif
   8072  1.1     skrll       )
   8073  1.1     skrll     {
   8074  1.1     skrll       pstatus_t pstat;
   8075  1.1     skrll 
   8076  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
   8077  1.1     skrll 
   8078  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = pstat.pr_pid;
   8079  1.1     skrll     }
   8080  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
   8081  1.1     skrll   else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
   8082  1.1     skrll     {
   8083  1.1     skrll       /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
   8084  1.1     skrll       pstatus32_t pstat;
   8085  1.1     skrll 
   8086  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
   8087  1.1     skrll 
   8088  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = pstat.pr_pid;
   8089  1.1     skrll     }
   8090  1.1     skrll #endif
   8091  1.1     skrll   /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
   8092  1.1     skrll      lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
   8093  1.1     skrll      NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably.  */
   8094  1.1     skrll 
   8095  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8096  1.1     skrll }
   8097  1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
   8098  1.1     skrll 
   8099  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
   8100  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8101  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8102  1.1     skrll {
   8103  1.1     skrll   lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
   8104  1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   8105  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   8106  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   8107  1.1     skrll   asection *sect;
   8108  1.1     skrll 
   8109  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
   8110  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
   8111  1.1     skrll       && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
   8112  1.1     skrll #endif
   8113  1.1     skrll       )
   8114  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   8115  1.3  christos 
   8116  1.3  christos   memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
   8117  1.3  christos 
   8118  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
   8119  1.1     skrll   /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
   8120  1.1     skrll      another thread.  */
   8121  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal == 0)
   8122  1.1     skrll     elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
   8123  1.1     skrll 
   8124  1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
   8125  1.1     skrll 
   8126  1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
   8127  1.1     skrll   len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   8128  1.1     skrll   name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   8129  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   8130  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8131  1.1     skrll   memcpy (name, buf, len);
   8132  1.1     skrll 
   8133  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8134  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   8135  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8136  1.1     skrll 
   8137  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
   8138  1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
   8139  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos
   8140  1.1     skrll     + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
   8141  1.1     skrll #endif
   8142  1.1     skrll 
   8143  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
   8144  1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
   8145  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
   8146  1.1     skrll #endif
   8147  1.1     skrll 
   8148  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   8149  1.1     skrll 
   8150  1.1     skrll   if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
   8151  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8152  1.1     skrll 
   8153  1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
   8154  1.1     skrll 
   8155  1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
   8156  1.1     skrll   len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   8157  1.1     skrll   name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   8158  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   8159  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8160  1.1     skrll   memcpy (name, buf, len);
   8161  1.1     skrll 
   8162  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8163  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   8164  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8165  1.1     skrll 
   8166  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
   8167  1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
   8168  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos
   8169  1.1     skrll     + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
   8170  1.1     skrll #endif
   8171  1.1     skrll 
   8172  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
   8173  1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
   8174  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
   8175  1.1     skrll #endif
   8176  1.1     skrll 
   8177  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   8178  1.1     skrll 
   8179  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
   8180  1.1     skrll }
   8181  1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
   8182  1.1     skrll 
   8183  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8184  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8185  1.1     skrll {
   8186  1.1     skrll   char buf[30];
   8187  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   8188  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   8189  1.1     skrll   asection *sect;
   8190  1.1     skrll   int type;
   8191  1.1     skrll   int is_active_thread;
   8192  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma base_addr;
   8193  1.1     skrll 
   8194  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz < 728)
   8195  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   8196  1.1     skrll 
   8197  1.1     skrll   if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
   8198  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   8199  1.1     skrll 
   8200  1.1     skrll   type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
   8201  1.1     skrll 
   8202  1.1     skrll   switch (type)
   8203  1.1     skrll     {
   8204  1.1     skrll     case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
   8205  1.1     skrll       /* FIXME: need to add ->core_command.  */
   8206  1.1     skrll       /* process_info.pid */
   8207  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
   8208  1.1     skrll       /* process_info.signal */
   8209  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
   8210  1.1     skrll       break;
   8211  1.1     skrll 
   8212  1.1     skrll     case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
   8213  1.3  christos       /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
   8214  1.1     skrll       /* thread_info.tid */
   8215  1.1     skrll       sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
   8216  1.1     skrll 
   8217  1.1     skrll       len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   8218  1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   8219  1.1     skrll       if (name == NULL)
   8220  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   8221  1.1     skrll 
   8222  1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, buf, len);
   8223  1.1     skrll 
   8224  1.1     skrll       sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8225  1.1     skrll       if (sect == NULL)
   8226  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   8227  1.1     skrll 
   8228  1.1     skrll       /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
   8229  1.1     skrll       sect->size = 716;
   8230  1.1     skrll       /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
   8231  1.1     skrll       sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
   8232  1.1     skrll       sect->alignment_power = 2;
   8233  1.1     skrll 
   8234  1.1     skrll       /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
   8235  1.1     skrll       is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
   8236  1.1     skrll 
   8237  1.1     skrll       if (is_active_thread)
   8238  1.1     skrll 	if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
   8239  1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   8240  1.1     skrll       break;
   8241  1.1     skrll 
   8242  1.1     skrll     case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
   8243  1.1     skrll       /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section.  */
   8244  1.3  christos       /* module_info.base_address */
   8245  1.1     skrll       base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
   8246  1.1     skrll       sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
   8247  1.1     skrll 
   8248  1.1     skrll       len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   8249  1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   8250  1.1     skrll       if (name == NULL)
   8251  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   8252  1.1     skrll 
   8253  1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, buf, len);
   8254  1.1     skrll 
   8255  1.1     skrll       sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8256  1.1     skrll 
   8257  1.1     skrll       if (sect == NULL)
   8258  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   8259  1.1     skrll 
   8260  1.1     skrll       sect->size = note->descsz;
   8261  1.1     skrll       sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   8262  1.1     skrll       sect->alignment_power = 2;
   8263  1.1     skrll       break;
   8264  1.1     skrll 
   8265  1.1     skrll     default:
   8266  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8267  1.1     skrll     }
   8268  1.1     skrll 
   8269  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8270  1.1     skrll }
   8271  1.1     skrll 
   8272  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8273  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8274  1.1     skrll {
   8275  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   8276  1.1     skrll 
   8277  1.1     skrll   switch (note->type)
   8278  1.1     skrll     {
   8279  1.1     skrll     default:
   8280  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8281  1.1     skrll 
   8282  1.1     skrll     case NT_PRSTATUS:
   8283  1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
   8284  1.1     skrll 	if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
   8285  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   8286  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
   8287  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
   8288  1.1     skrll #else
   8289  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8290  1.1     skrll #endif
   8291  1.1     skrll 
   8292  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
   8293  1.1     skrll     case NT_PSTATUS:
   8294  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
   8295  1.1     skrll #endif
   8296  1.1     skrll 
   8297  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
   8298  1.1     skrll     case NT_LWPSTATUS:
   8299  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
   8300  1.1     skrll #endif
   8301  1.1     skrll 
   8302  1.1     skrll     case NT_FPREGSET:		/* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
   8303  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
   8304  1.1     skrll 
   8305  1.1     skrll     case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
   8306  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
   8307  1.1     skrll 
   8308  1.1     skrll     case NT_PRXFPREG:		/* Linux SSE extension */
   8309  1.1     skrll       if (note->namesz == 6
   8310  1.3  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   8311  1.3  christos 	return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
   8312  1.3  christos       else
   8313  1.3  christos 	return TRUE;
   8314  1.3  christos 
   8315  1.3  christos     case NT_X86_XSTATE:		/* Linux XSAVE extension */
   8316  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   8317  1.1     skrll 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   8318  1.1     skrll 	return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
   8319  1.1     skrll       else
   8320  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   8321  1.1     skrll 
   8322  1.1     skrll     case NT_PPC_VMX:
   8323  1.1     skrll       if (note->namesz == 6
   8324  1.1     skrll 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   8325  1.1     skrll 	return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
   8326  1.1     skrll       else
   8327  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   8328  1.1     skrll 
   8329  1.1     skrll     case NT_PPC_VSX:
   8330  1.1     skrll       if (note->namesz == 6
   8331  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   8332  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
   8333  1.3  christos       else
   8334  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   8335  1.3  christos 
   8336  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
   8337  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   8338  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   8339  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
   8340  1.3  christos       else
   8341  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   8342  1.3  christos 
   8343  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_TIMER:
   8344  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   8345  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   8346  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
   8347  1.3  christos       else
   8348  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   8349  1.3  christos 
   8350  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_TODCMP:
   8351  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   8352  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   8353  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
   8354  1.3  christos       else
   8355  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   8356  1.3  christos 
   8357  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_TODPREG:
   8358  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   8359  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   8360  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
   8361  1.3  christos       else
   8362  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   8363  1.3  christos 
   8364  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_CTRS:
   8365  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   8366  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   8367  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
   8368  1.3  christos       else
   8369  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   8370  1.3  christos 
   8371  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_PREFIX:
   8372  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   8373  1.1     skrll           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   8374  1.1     skrll         return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
   8375  1.1     skrll       else
   8376  1.1     skrll         return TRUE;
   8377  1.1     skrll 
   8378  1.1     skrll     case NT_PRPSINFO:
   8379  1.1     skrll     case NT_PSINFO:
   8380  1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
   8381  1.1     skrll 	if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
   8382  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   8383  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   8384  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
   8385  1.1     skrll #else
   8386  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8387  1.1     skrll #endif
   8388  1.1     skrll 
   8389  1.1     skrll     case NT_AUXV:
   8390  1.1     skrll       {
   8391  1.1     skrll 	asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
   8392  1.1     skrll 							     SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8393  1.1     skrll 
   8394  1.1     skrll 	if (sect == NULL)
   8395  1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   8396  1.1     skrll 	sect->size = note->descsz;
   8397  1.1     skrll 	sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   8398  1.1     skrll 	sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
   8399  1.1     skrll 
   8400  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   8401  1.1     skrll       }
   8402  1.1     skrll     }
   8403  1.1     skrll }
   8404  1.3  christos 
   8405  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8406  1.1     skrll elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8407  1.1     skrll {
   8408  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id_size = note->descsz;
   8409  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, note->descsz);
   8410  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id == NULL)
   8411  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8412  1.1     skrll 
   8413  1.1     skrll   memcpy (elf_tdata (abfd)->build_id, note->descdata, note->descsz);
   8414  1.1     skrll 
   8415  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8416  1.1     skrll }
   8417  1.1     skrll 
   8418  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8419  1.1     skrll elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8420  1.1     skrll {
   8421  1.1     skrll   switch (note->type)
   8422  1.1     skrll     {
   8423  1.1     skrll     default:
   8424  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8425  1.1     skrll 
   8426  1.1     skrll     case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
   8427  1.1     skrll       return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
   8428  1.1     skrll     }
   8429  1.1     skrll }
   8430  1.1     skrll 
   8431  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8432  1.1     skrll elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
   8433  1.1     skrll {
   8434  1.1     skrll   char *cp;
   8435  1.1     skrll 
   8436  1.1     skrll   cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
   8437  1.1     skrll   if (cp != NULL)
   8438  1.1     skrll     {
   8439  1.1     skrll       *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
   8440  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8441  1.1     skrll     }
   8442  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   8443  1.1     skrll }
   8444  1.1     skrll 
   8445  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8446  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8447  1.1     skrll {
   8448  1.1     skrll   /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
   8449  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal
   8450  1.1     skrll     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
   8451  1.1     skrll 
   8452  1.1     skrll   /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
   8453  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid
   8454  1.1     skrll     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
   8455  1.1     skrll 
   8456  1.1     skrll   /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
   8457  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
   8458  1.1     skrll     = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
   8459  1.1     skrll 
   8460  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
   8461  1.1     skrll 					  note);
   8462  1.1     skrll }
   8463  1.1     skrll 
   8464  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8465  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8466  1.1     skrll {
   8467  1.1     skrll   int lwp;
   8468  1.1     skrll 
   8469  1.1     skrll   if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
   8470  1.1     skrll     elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = lwp;
   8471  1.1     skrll 
   8472  1.1     skrll   if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
   8473  1.1     skrll     {
   8474  1.1     skrll       /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo".  Note that we expect to
   8475  1.1     skrll 	 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
   8476  1.1     skrll 	 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
   8477  1.1     skrll 	 creates a core file.  */
   8478  1.1     skrll 
   8479  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
   8480  1.1     skrll     }
   8481  1.1     skrll 
   8482  1.1     skrll   /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
   8483  1.1     skrll      defined for NetBSD core files.  If the note type is less
   8484  1.1     skrll      than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
   8485  1.1     skrll      understand it.  */
   8486  1.1     skrll 
   8487  1.1     skrll   if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
   8488  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   8489  1.1     skrll 
   8490  1.1     skrll 
   8491  1.1     skrll   switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
   8492  1.1     skrll     {
   8493  1.1     skrll       /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
   8494  1.1     skrll 	 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2.  */
   8495  1.1     skrll 
   8496  1.1     skrll     case bfd_arch_alpha:
   8497  1.1     skrll     case bfd_arch_sparc:
   8498  1.1     skrll       switch (note->type)
   8499  1.1     skrll 	{
   8500  1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
   8501  1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
   8502  1.1     skrll 
   8503  1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
   8504  1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   8505  1.1     skrll 
   8506  1.1     skrll 	default:
   8507  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   8508  1.1     skrll 	}
   8509  1.1     skrll 
   8510  1.1     skrll       /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
   8511  1.1     skrll 	 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3.  */
   8512  1.1     skrll 
   8513  1.1     skrll     default:
   8514  1.1     skrll       switch (note->type)
   8515  1.1     skrll 	{
   8516  1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
   8517  1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
   8518  1.1     skrll 
   8519  1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
   8520  1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   8521  1.1     skrll 
   8522  1.1     skrll 	default:
   8523  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   8524  1.1     skrll 	}
   8525  1.3  christos     }
   8526  1.3  christos     /* NOTREACHED */
   8527  1.3  christos }
   8528  1.3  christos 
   8529  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   8530  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8531  1.3  christos {
   8532  1.3  christos   /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
   8533  1.3  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal
   8534  1.3  christos     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
   8535  1.3  christos 
   8536  1.3  christos   /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
   8537  1.3  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid
   8538  1.3  christos     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
   8539  1.3  christos 
   8540  1.3  christos   /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
   8541  1.3  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
   8542  1.3  christos     = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
   8543  1.3  christos 
   8544  1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   8545  1.3  christos }
   8546  1.3  christos 
   8547  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   8548  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8549  1.3  christos {
   8550  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
   8551  1.3  christos     return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
   8552  1.3  christos 
   8553  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
   8554  1.3  christos     return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
   8555  1.3  christos 
   8556  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
   8557  1.3  christos     return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   8558  1.3  christos 
   8559  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
   8560  1.3  christos     return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
   8561  1.3  christos 
   8562  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
   8563  1.3  christos     {
   8564  1.3  christos       asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
   8565  1.3  christos 							   SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8566  1.3  christos 
   8567  1.3  christos       if (sect == NULL)
   8568  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   8569  1.3  christos       sect->size = note->descsz;
   8570  1.3  christos       sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   8571  1.3  christos       sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
   8572  1.3  christos 
   8573  1.3  christos       return TRUE;
   8574  1.3  christos     }
   8575  1.3  christos 
   8576  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
   8577  1.3  christos     {
   8578  1.3  christos       asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
   8579  1.3  christos 							   SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8580  1.3  christos 
   8581  1.3  christos       if (sect == NULL)
   8582  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   8583  1.3  christos       sect->size = note->descsz;
   8584  1.3  christos       sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   8585  1.3  christos       sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
   8586  1.3  christos 
   8587  1.3  christos       return TRUE;
   8588  1.3  christos     }
   8589  1.1     skrll 
   8590  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8591  1.1     skrll }
   8592  1.1     skrll 
   8593  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8594  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
   8595  1.1     skrll {
   8596  1.1     skrll   void *ddata = note->descdata;
   8597  1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   8598  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   8599  1.1     skrll   asection *sect;
   8600  1.1     skrll   short sig;
   8601  1.1     skrll   unsigned flags;
   8602  1.1     skrll 
   8603  1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0.  */
   8604  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
   8605  1.1     skrll 
   8606  1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4.  Pass it back.  */
   8607  1.1     skrll   *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
   8608  1.1     skrll 
   8609  1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8.  */
   8610  1.1     skrll   flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
   8611  1.1     skrll 
   8612  1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14.  */
   8613  1.1     skrll   if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
   8614  1.1     skrll     {
   8615  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = sig;
   8616  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = *tid;
   8617  1.1     skrll     }
   8618  1.1     skrll 
   8619  1.1     skrll   /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80.  Some cores
   8620  1.1     skrll      do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
   8621  1.1     skrll      thread just in case.  */
   8622  1.1     skrll   if (flags & 0x00000080)
   8623  1.3  christos     elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid = *tid;
   8624  1.1     skrll 
   8625  1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section.  */
   8626  1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
   8627  1.1     skrll 
   8628  1.1     skrll   name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
   8629  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   8630  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8631  1.1     skrll   strcpy (name, buf);
   8632  1.1     skrll 
   8633  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8634  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   8635  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8636  1.1     skrll 
   8637  1.1     skrll   sect->size            = note->descsz;
   8638  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos         = note->descpos;
   8639  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   8640  1.1     skrll 
   8641  1.1     skrll   return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
   8642  1.1     skrll }
   8643  1.1     skrll 
   8644  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8645  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
   8646  1.1     skrll 		       Elf_Internal_Note *note,
   8647  1.1     skrll 		       long tid,
   8648  1.1     skrll 		       char *base)
   8649  1.1     skrll {
   8650  1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   8651  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   8652  1.3  christos   asection *sect;
   8653  1.1     skrll 
   8654  1.1     skrll   /* Make a "(base)/%d" section.  */
   8655  1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
   8656  1.1     skrll 
   8657  1.1     skrll   name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
   8658  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   8659  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8660  1.1     skrll   strcpy (name, buf);
   8661  1.1     skrll 
   8662  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8663  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   8664  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8665  1.1     skrll 
   8666  1.1     skrll   sect->size            = note->descsz;
   8667  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos         = note->descpos;
   8668  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   8669  1.1     skrll 
   8670  1.1     skrll   /* This is the current thread.  */
   8671  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core_lwpid == tid)
   8672  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
   8673  1.1     skrll 
   8674  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8675  1.1     skrll }
   8676  1.1     skrll 
   8677  1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO	7
   8678  1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS	8
   8679  1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG	9
   8680  1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG	10
   8681  1.1     skrll 
   8682  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8683  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8684  1.1     skrll {
   8685  1.1     skrll   /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it.  Store the
   8686  1.1     skrll      tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
   8687  1.1     skrll      function.  */
   8688  1.1     skrll   static long tid = 1;
   8689  1.1     skrll 
   8690  1.1     skrll   switch (note->type)
   8691  1.1     skrll     {
   8692  1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
   8693  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
   8694  1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
   8695  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
   8696  1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
   8697  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
   8698  1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
   8699  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
   8700  1.1     skrll     default:
   8701  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8702  1.1     skrll     }
   8703  1.1     skrll }
   8704  1.1     skrll 
   8705  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8706  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8707  1.1     skrll {
   8708  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   8709  1.3  christos   asection *sect;
   8710  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   8711  1.1     skrll 
   8712  1.1     skrll   /* Use note name as section name.  */
   8713  1.1     skrll   len = note->namesz;
   8714  1.1     skrll   name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   8715  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   8716  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8717  1.1     skrll   memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
   8718  1.1     skrll   name[len - 1] = '\0';
   8719  1.1     skrll 
   8720  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8721  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   8722  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8723  1.1     skrll 
   8724  1.1     skrll   sect->size            = note->descsz;
   8725  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos         = note->descpos;
   8726  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 1;
   8727  1.1     skrll 
   8728  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8729  1.1     skrll }
   8730  1.1     skrll 
   8731  1.1     skrll /* Function: elfcore_write_note
   8732  1.1     skrll 
   8733  1.1     skrll    Inputs:
   8734  1.1     skrll      buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
   8735  1.1     skrll      name of note
   8736  1.1     skrll      type of note
   8737  1.1     skrll      data for note
   8738  1.1     skrll      size of data for note
   8739  1.1     skrll 
   8740  1.1     skrll    Writes note to end of buffer.  ELF64 notes are written exactly as
   8741  1.1     skrll    for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
   8742  1.1     skrll    that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
   8743  1.1     skrll    8-byte alignment.  Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
   8744  1.1     skrll 
   8745  1.1     skrll    Return:
   8746  1.1     skrll    Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated.  */
   8747  1.1     skrll 
   8748  1.1     skrll char *
   8749  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
   8750  1.1     skrll 		    char *buf,
   8751  1.1     skrll 		    int *bufsiz,
   8752  1.1     skrll 		    const char *name,
   8753  1.1     skrll 		    int type,
   8754  1.1     skrll 		    const void *input,
   8755  1.1     skrll 		    int size)
   8756  1.1     skrll {
   8757  1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Note *xnp;
   8758  1.1     skrll   size_t namesz;
   8759  1.1     skrll   size_t newspace;
   8760  1.1     skrll   char *dest;
   8761  1.1     skrll 
   8762  1.1     skrll   namesz = 0;
   8763  1.3  christos   if (name != NULL)
   8764  1.1     skrll     namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
   8765  1.1     skrll 
   8766  1.1     skrll   newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
   8767  1.1     skrll 
   8768  1.1     skrll   buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
   8769  1.1     skrll   if (buf == NULL)
   8770  1.1     skrll     return buf;
   8771  1.1     skrll   dest = buf + *bufsiz;
   8772  1.1     skrll   *bufsiz += newspace;
   8773  1.1     skrll   xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
   8774  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
   8775  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
   8776  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
   8777  1.1     skrll   dest = xnp->name;
   8778  1.1     skrll   if (name != NULL)
   8779  1.1     skrll     {
   8780  1.1     skrll       memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
   8781  1.1     skrll       dest += namesz;
   8782  1.1     skrll       while (namesz & 3)
   8783  1.1     skrll 	{
   8784  1.1     skrll 	  *dest++ = '\0';
   8785  1.1     skrll 	  ++namesz;
   8786  1.1     skrll 	}
   8787  1.1     skrll     }
   8788  1.1     skrll   memcpy (dest, input, size);
   8789  1.1     skrll   dest += size;
   8790  1.1     skrll   while (size & 3)
   8791  1.1     skrll     {
   8792  1.1     skrll       *dest++ = '\0';
   8793  1.1     skrll       ++size;
   8794  1.1     skrll     }
   8795  1.1     skrll   return buf;
   8796  1.1     skrll }
   8797  1.1     skrll 
   8798  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   8799  1.1     skrll char *
   8800  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd  *abfd,
   8801  1.1     skrll 			char *buf,
   8802  1.1     skrll 			int  *bufsiz,
   8803  1.1     skrll 			const char *fname,
   8804  1.1     skrll 			const char *psargs)
   8805  1.1     skrll {
   8806  1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   8807  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   8808  1.1     skrll 
   8809  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
   8810  1.1     skrll     {
   8811  1.1     skrll       char *ret;
   8812  1.1     skrll       ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   8813  1.1     skrll 						 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
   8814  1.1     skrll       if (ret != NULL)
   8815  1.1     skrll 	return ret;
   8816  1.1     skrll     }
   8817  1.1     skrll 
   8818  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
   8819  1.1     skrll   if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
   8820  1.1     skrll     {
   8821  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
   8822  1.1     skrll       psinfo32_t data;
   8823  1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
   8824  1.1     skrll #else
   8825  1.1     skrll       prpsinfo32_t data;
   8826  1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
   8827  1.1     skrll #endif
   8828  1.1     skrll 
   8829  1.1     skrll       memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
   8830  1.1     skrll       strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
   8831  1.1     skrll       strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
   8832  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   8833  1.1     skrll 				 note_name, note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
   8834  1.1     skrll     }
   8835  1.1     skrll   else
   8836  1.1     skrll #endif
   8837  1.1     skrll     {
   8838  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   8839  1.1     skrll       psinfo_t data;
   8840  1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
   8841  1.1     skrll #else
   8842  1.1     skrll       prpsinfo_t data;
   8843  1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
   8844  1.1     skrll #endif
   8845  1.1     skrll 
   8846  1.1     skrll       memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
   8847  1.1     skrll       strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
   8848  1.1     skrll       strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
   8849  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   8850  1.1     skrll 				 note_name, note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
   8851  1.1     skrll     }
   8852  1.1     skrll }
   8853  1.1     skrll #endif	/* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
   8854  1.1     skrll 
   8855  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
   8856  1.1     skrll char *
   8857  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
   8858  1.1     skrll 			char *buf,
   8859  1.1     skrll 			int *bufsiz,
   8860  1.1     skrll 			long pid,
   8861  1.1     skrll 			int cursig,
   8862  1.1     skrll 			const void *gregs)
   8863  1.1     skrll {
   8864  1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   8865  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   8866  1.1     skrll 
   8867  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
   8868  1.1     skrll     {
   8869  1.1     skrll       char *ret;
   8870  1.1     skrll       ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   8871  1.1     skrll 						 NT_PRSTATUS,
   8872  1.1     skrll 						 pid, cursig, gregs);
   8873  1.1     skrll       if (ret != NULL)
   8874  1.1     skrll 	return ret;
   8875  1.1     skrll     }
   8876  1.1     skrll 
   8877  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
   8878  1.1     skrll   if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
   8879  1.1     skrll     {
   8880  1.1     skrll       prstatus32_t prstat;
   8881  1.1     skrll 
   8882  1.1     skrll       memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
   8883  1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_pid = pid;
   8884  1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
   8885  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
   8886  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   8887  1.1     skrll 				 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
   8888  1.1     skrll     }
   8889  1.1     skrll   else
   8890  1.1     skrll #endif
   8891  1.1     skrll     {
   8892  1.1     skrll       prstatus_t prstat;
   8893  1.1     skrll 
   8894  1.1     skrll       memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
   8895  1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_pid = pid;
   8896  1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
   8897  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
   8898  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   8899  1.1     skrll 				 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
   8900  1.1     skrll     }
   8901  1.1     skrll }
   8902  1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
   8903  1.1     skrll 
   8904  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
   8905  1.1     skrll char *
   8906  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
   8907  1.1     skrll 			 char *buf,
   8908  1.1     skrll 			 int *bufsiz,
   8909  1.1     skrll 			 long pid,
   8910  1.1     skrll 			 int cursig,
   8911  1.1     skrll 			 const void *gregs)
   8912  1.1     skrll {
   8913  1.1     skrll   lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
   8914  1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   8915  1.1     skrll 
   8916  1.1     skrll   memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
   8917  1.1     skrll   lwpstat.pr_lwpid  = pid >> 16;
   8918  1.1     skrll   lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
   8919  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
   8920  1.1     skrll   memcpy (lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
   8921  1.1     skrll #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
   8922  1.1     skrll #if !defined(gregs)
   8923  1.1     skrll   memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
   8924  1.1     skrll 	  gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
   8925  1.1     skrll #else
   8926  1.1     skrll   memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
   8927  1.1     skrll 	  gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
   8928  1.1     skrll #endif
   8929  1.1     skrll #endif
   8930  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   8931  1.1     skrll 			     NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
   8932  1.1     skrll }
   8933  1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
   8934  1.1     skrll 
   8935  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
   8936  1.1     skrll char *
   8937  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
   8938  1.1     skrll 		       char *buf,
   8939  1.1     skrll 		       int *bufsiz,
   8940  1.1     skrll 		       long pid,
   8941  1.1     skrll 		       int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8942  1.1     skrll 		       const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   8943  1.1     skrll {
   8944  1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   8945  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
   8946  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   8947  1.1     skrll 
   8948  1.1     skrll   if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
   8949  1.1     skrll     {
   8950  1.1     skrll       pstatus32_t pstat;
   8951  1.1     skrll 
   8952  1.1     skrll       memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
   8953  1.1     skrll       pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
   8954  1.1     skrll       buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   8955  1.1     skrll 				NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
   8956  1.1     skrll       return buf;
   8957  1.1     skrll     }
   8958  1.1     skrll   else
   8959  1.1     skrll #endif
   8960  1.1     skrll     {
   8961  1.1     skrll       pstatus_t pstat;
   8962  1.1     skrll 
   8963  1.1     skrll       memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
   8964  1.1     skrll       pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
   8965  1.1     skrll       buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   8966  1.1     skrll 				NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
   8967  1.1     skrll       return buf;
   8968  1.1     skrll     }
   8969  1.1     skrll }
   8970  1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
   8971  1.1     skrll 
   8972  1.1     skrll char *
   8973  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
   8974  1.1     skrll 		       char *buf,
   8975  1.1     skrll 		       int *bufsiz,
   8976  1.1     skrll 		       const void *fpregs,
   8977  1.1     skrll 		       int size)
   8978  1.1     skrll {
   8979  1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   8980  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   8981  1.1     skrll 			     note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
   8982  1.1     skrll }
   8983  1.1     skrll 
   8984  1.1     skrll char *
   8985  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
   8986  1.1     skrll 			char *buf,
   8987  1.1     skrll 			int *bufsiz,
   8988  1.1     skrll 			const void *xfpregs,
   8989  1.1     skrll 			int size)
   8990  1.1     skrll {
   8991  1.1     skrll   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   8992  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   8993  1.3  christos 			     note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
   8994  1.3  christos }
   8995  1.3  christos 
   8996  1.3  christos char *
   8997  1.3  christos elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
   8998  1.3  christos 			 const void *xfpregs, int size)
   8999  1.3  christos {
   9000  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9001  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9002  1.1     skrll 			     note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
   9003  1.1     skrll }
   9004  1.1     skrll 
   9005  1.1     skrll char *
   9006  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
   9007  1.1     skrll 		       char *buf,
   9008  1.1     skrll 		       int *bufsiz,
   9009  1.1     skrll 		       const void *ppc_vmx,
   9010  1.1     skrll 		       int size)
   9011  1.1     skrll {
   9012  1.1     skrll   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9013  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9014  1.1     skrll 			     note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
   9015  1.1     skrll }
   9016  1.1     skrll 
   9017  1.1     skrll char *
   9018  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
   9019  1.1     skrll                        char *buf,
   9020  1.1     skrll                        int *bufsiz,
   9021  1.1     skrll                        const void *ppc_vsx,
   9022  1.1     skrll                        int size)
   9023  1.1     skrll {
   9024  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9025  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9026  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
   9027  1.3  christos }
   9028  1.3  christos 
   9029  1.3  christos static char *
   9030  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
   9031  1.3  christos 			      char *buf,
   9032  1.3  christos 			      int *bufsiz,
   9033  1.3  christos 			      const void *s390_high_gprs,
   9034  1.3  christos 			      int size)
   9035  1.3  christos {
   9036  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9037  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9038  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
   9039  1.3  christos 			     s390_high_gprs, size);
   9040  1.3  christos }
   9041  1.3  christos 
   9042  1.3  christos char *
   9043  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
   9044  1.3  christos                           char *buf,
   9045  1.3  christos                           int *bufsiz,
   9046  1.3  christos                           const void *s390_timer,
   9047  1.3  christos                           int size)
   9048  1.3  christos {
   9049  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9050  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9051  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
   9052  1.3  christos }
   9053  1.3  christos 
   9054  1.3  christos char *
   9055  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
   9056  1.3  christos                            char *buf,
   9057  1.3  christos                            int *bufsiz,
   9058  1.3  christos                            const void *s390_todcmp,
   9059  1.3  christos                            int size)
   9060  1.3  christos {
   9061  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9062  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9063  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
   9064  1.3  christos }
   9065  1.3  christos 
   9066  1.3  christos char *
   9067  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
   9068  1.3  christos                             char *buf,
   9069  1.3  christos                             int *bufsiz,
   9070  1.3  christos                             const void *s390_todpreg,
   9071  1.3  christos                             int size)
   9072  1.3  christos {
   9073  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9074  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9075  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
   9076  1.3  christos }
   9077  1.3  christos 
   9078  1.3  christos char *
   9079  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
   9080  1.3  christos                          char *buf,
   9081  1.3  christos                          int *bufsiz,
   9082  1.3  christos                          const void *s390_ctrs,
   9083  1.3  christos                          int size)
   9084  1.3  christos {
   9085  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9086  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9087  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
   9088  1.3  christos }
   9089  1.3  christos 
   9090  1.3  christos char *
   9091  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
   9092  1.3  christos                            char *buf,
   9093  1.3  christos                            int *bufsiz,
   9094  1.3  christos                            const void *s390_prefix,
   9095  1.3  christos                            int size)
   9096  1.3  christos {
   9097  1.1     skrll   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9098  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9099  1.1     skrll                              note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
   9100  1.1     skrll }
   9101  1.1     skrll 
   9102  1.1     skrll char *
   9103  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
   9104  1.1     skrll 			     char *buf,
   9105  1.1     skrll 			     int *bufsiz,
   9106  1.1     skrll 			     const char *section,
   9107  1.1     skrll 			     const void *data,
   9108  1.1     skrll 			     int size)
   9109  1.3  christos {
   9110  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
   9111  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9112  1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
   9113  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9114  1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
   9115  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9116  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
   9117  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9118  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
   9119  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9120  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
   9121  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9122  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
   9123  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9124  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
   9125  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9126  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
   9127  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9128  1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
   9129  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9130  1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
   9131  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   9132  1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   9133  1.1     skrll }
   9134  1.1     skrll 
   9135  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9136  1.1     skrll elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset)
   9137  1.1     skrll {
   9138  1.1     skrll   char *p;
   9139  1.1     skrll 
   9140  1.1     skrll   p = buf;
   9141  1.1     skrll   while (p < buf + size)
   9142  1.1     skrll     {
   9143  1.1     skrll       /* FIXME: bad alignment assumption.  */
   9144  1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
   9145  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Note in;
   9146  1.1     skrll 
   9147  1.1     skrll       if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
   9148  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9149  1.1     skrll 
   9150  1.1     skrll       in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
   9151  1.1     skrll 
   9152  1.1     skrll       in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
   9153  1.1     skrll       in.namedata = xnp->name;
   9154  1.1     skrll       if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
   9155  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9156  1.1     skrll 
   9157  1.1     skrll       in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
   9158  1.1     skrll       in.descdata = in.namedata + BFD_ALIGN (in.namesz, 4);
   9159  1.1     skrll       in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
   9160  1.1     skrll       if (in.descsz != 0
   9161  1.1     skrll 	  && (in.descdata >= buf + size
   9162  1.1     skrll 	      || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
   9163  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9164  1.1     skrll 
   9165  1.1     skrll       switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
   9166  1.1     skrll         {
   9167  1.1     skrll 	default:
   9168  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   9169  1.1     skrll 
   9170  1.1     skrll 	case bfd_core:
   9171  1.3  christos 	  if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "NetBSD-CORE"))
   9172  1.3  christos 	    {
   9173  1.3  christos 	      if (! elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (abfd, &in))
   9174  1.3  christos 		return FALSE;
   9175  1.3  christos 	    }
   9176  1.1     skrll 	  else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "OpenBSD"))
   9177  1.1     skrll 	    {
   9178  1.1     skrll 	      if (! elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (abfd, &in))
   9179  1.1     skrll 		return FALSE;
   9180  1.1     skrll 	    }
   9181  1.1     skrll 	  else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "QNX"))
   9182  1.1     skrll 	    {
   9183  1.1     skrll 	      if (! elfcore_grok_nto_note (abfd, &in))
   9184  1.1     skrll 		return FALSE;
   9185  1.1     skrll 	    }
   9186  1.1     skrll 	  else if (CONST_STRNEQ (in.namedata, "SPU/"))
   9187  1.1     skrll 	    {
   9188  1.1     skrll 	      if (! elfcore_grok_spu_note (abfd, &in))
   9189  1.1     skrll 		return FALSE;
   9190  1.1     skrll 	    }
   9191  1.1     skrll 	  else
   9192  1.1     skrll 	    {
   9193  1.1     skrll 	      if (! elfcore_grok_note (abfd, &in))
   9194  1.1     skrll 		return FALSE;
   9195  1.1     skrll 	    }
   9196  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   9197  1.1     skrll 
   9198  1.1     skrll 	case bfd_object:
   9199  1.1     skrll 	  if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
   9200  1.1     skrll 	    {
   9201  1.1     skrll 	      if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
   9202  1.1     skrll 		return FALSE;
   9203  1.1     skrll 	    }
   9204  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   9205  1.1     skrll 	}
   9206  1.1     skrll 
   9207  1.1     skrll       p = in.descdata + BFD_ALIGN (in.descsz, 4);
   9208  1.1     skrll     }
   9209  1.1     skrll 
   9210  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9211  1.1     skrll }
   9212  1.1     skrll 
   9213  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9214  1.1     skrll elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size)
   9215  1.1     skrll {
   9216  1.1     skrll   char *buf;
   9217  1.1     skrll 
   9218  1.1     skrll   if (size <= 0)
   9219  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   9220  1.1     skrll 
   9221  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
   9222  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9223  1.1     skrll 
   9224  1.1     skrll   buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size);
   9225  1.1     skrll   if (buf == NULL)
   9226  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9227  1.1     skrll 
   9228  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
   9229  1.1     skrll       || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset))
   9230  1.1     skrll     {
   9231  1.1     skrll       free (buf);
   9232  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   9233  1.1     skrll     }
   9234  1.1     skrll 
   9235  1.1     skrll   free (buf);
   9236  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9237  1.1     skrll }
   9238  1.1     skrll 
   9239  1.1     skrll /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table.  */
   9241  1.1     skrll 
   9242  1.1     skrll /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
   9243  1.1     skrll    copy of ABFD's program header table entries.  Return -1 if an error
   9244  1.1     skrll    occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code.  */
   9245  1.1     skrll 
   9246  1.1     skrll long
   9247  1.1     skrll bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   9248  1.1     skrll {
   9249  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   9250  1.1     skrll     {
   9251  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
   9252  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   9253  1.1     skrll     }
   9254  1.1     skrll 
   9255  1.1     skrll   return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
   9256  1.1     skrll }
   9257  1.1     skrll 
   9258  1.1     skrll /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS.  The entries
   9259  1.1     skrll    will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
   9260  1.1     skrll    defined in include/elf/internal.h.  To find out how large the
   9261  1.1     skrll    buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
   9262  1.1     skrll 
   9263  1.1     skrll    Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
   9264  1.1     skrll    error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code.  */
   9265  1.1     skrll 
   9266  1.1     skrll int
   9267  1.1     skrll bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
   9268  1.1     skrll {
   9269  1.1     skrll   int num_phdrs;
   9270  1.1     skrll 
   9271  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   9272  1.1     skrll     {
   9273  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
   9274  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   9275  1.1     skrll     }
   9276  1.1     skrll 
   9277  1.1     skrll   num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
   9278  1.1     skrll   memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
   9279  1.1     skrll 	  num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
   9280  1.1     skrll 
   9281  1.1     skrll   return num_phdrs;
   9282  1.1     skrll }
   9283  1.1     skrll 
   9284  1.1     skrll enum elf_reloc_type_class
   9285  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   9286  1.1     skrll {
   9287  1.1     skrll   return reloc_class_normal;
   9288  1.1     skrll }
   9289  1.1     skrll 
   9290  1.1     skrll /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
   9291  1.1     skrll    relocation against a local symbol.  */
   9292  1.1     skrll 
   9293  1.1     skrll bfd_vma
   9294  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
   9295  1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   9296  1.1     skrll 			 asection **psec,
   9297  1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   9298  1.1     skrll {
   9299  1.1     skrll   asection *sec = *psec;
   9300  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma relocation;
   9301  1.1     skrll 
   9302  1.1     skrll   relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
   9303  1.1     skrll 		+ sec->output_offset
   9304  1.1     skrll 		+ sym->st_value);
   9305  1.1     skrll   if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
   9306  1.1     skrll       && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
   9307  1.1     skrll       && sec->sec_info_type == ELF_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
   9308  1.1     skrll     {
   9309  1.1     skrll       rel->r_addend =
   9310  1.1     skrll 	_bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
   9311  1.1     skrll 				    elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
   9312  1.1     skrll 				    sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
   9313  1.1     skrll       if (sec != *psec)
   9314  1.1     skrll 	{
   9315  1.1     skrll 	  /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
   9316  1.1     skrll 	     marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
   9317  1.1     skrll 	     SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
   9318  1.1     skrll 	     other SEC_MERGE section.  In this case, we need to leave
   9319  1.1     skrll 	     some info around for --emit-relocs.  */
   9320  1.1     skrll 	  if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
   9321  1.1     skrll 	    sec->kept_section = *psec;
   9322  1.1     skrll 	  sec = *psec;
   9323  1.1     skrll 	}
   9324  1.1     skrll       rel->r_addend -= relocation;
   9325  1.1     skrll       rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
   9326  1.1     skrll     }
   9327  1.1     skrll   return relocation;
   9328  1.1     skrll }
   9329  1.1     skrll 
   9330  1.1     skrll bfd_vma
   9331  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
   9332  1.1     skrll 			Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   9333  1.1     skrll 			asection **psec,
   9334  1.1     skrll 			bfd_vma addend)
   9335  1.1     skrll {
   9336  1.1     skrll   asection *sec = *psec;
   9337  1.1     skrll 
   9338  1.1     skrll   if (sec->sec_info_type != ELF_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
   9339  1.1     skrll     return sym->st_value + addend;
   9340  1.1     skrll 
   9341  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
   9342  1.1     skrll 				     elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
   9343  1.1     skrll 				     sym->st_value + addend);
   9344  1.1     skrll }
   9345  1.1     skrll 
   9346  1.1     skrll bfd_vma
   9347  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
   9348  1.1     skrll 			 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   9349  1.1     skrll 			 asection *sec,
   9350  1.1     skrll 			 bfd_vma offset)
   9351  1.1     skrll {
   9352  1.1     skrll   switch (sec->sec_info_type)
   9353  1.1     skrll     {
   9354  1.1     skrll     case ELF_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
   9355  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
   9356  1.1     skrll 				       offset);
   9357  1.1     skrll     case ELF_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
   9358  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
   9359  1.1     skrll     default:
   9360  1.1     skrll       return offset;
   9361  1.1     skrll     }
   9362  1.1     skrll }
   9363  1.1     skrll 
   9364  1.1     skrll /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr.  Rather than opening a file,
   9366  1.1     skrll    reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
   9367  1.1     skrll    based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
   9368  1.1     skrll    points to.  If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
   9369  1.1     skrll    between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
   9370  1.1     skrll    file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
   9371  1.1     skrll 
   9372  1.1     skrll    The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
   9373  1.1     skrll    remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
   9374  1.1     skrll    should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure.  TEMPL must
   9375  1.1     skrll    be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
   9376  1.1     skrll    the remote memory.  */
   9377  1.1     skrll 
   9378  1.1     skrll bfd *
   9379  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
   9380  1.1     skrll   (bfd *templ,
   9381  1.1     skrll    bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
   9382  1.1     skrll    bfd_vma *loadbasep,
   9383  1.1     skrll    int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, int))
   9384  1.1     skrll {
   9385  1.1     skrll   return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
   9386  1.1     skrll     (templ, ehdr_vma, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
   9387  1.1     skrll }
   9388  1.1     skrll 
   9389  1.1     skrll long
   9391  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
   9392  1.1     skrll 			       long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   9393  1.1     skrll 			       asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   9394  1.1     skrll 			       long dynsymcount,
   9395  1.1     skrll 			       asymbol **dynsyms,
   9396  1.1     skrll 			       asymbol **ret)
   9397  1.1     skrll {
   9398  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   9399  1.1     skrll   asection *relplt;
   9400  1.1     skrll   asymbol *s;
   9401  1.1     skrll   const char *relplt_name;
   9402  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
   9403  1.1     skrll   arelent *p;
   9404  1.1     skrll   long count, i, n;
   9405  1.1     skrll   size_t size;
   9406  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   9407  1.1     skrll   char *names;
   9408  1.1     skrll   asection *plt;
   9409  1.1     skrll 
   9410  1.1     skrll   *ret = NULL;
   9411  1.1     skrll 
   9412  1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
   9413  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   9414  1.1     skrll 
   9415  1.1     skrll   if (dynsymcount <= 0)
   9416  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   9417  1.1     skrll 
   9418  1.1     skrll   if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
   9419  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   9420  1.1     skrll 
   9421  1.1     skrll   relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
   9422  1.1     skrll   if (relplt_name == NULL)
   9423  1.1     skrll     relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
   9424  1.1     skrll   relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
   9425  1.1     skrll   if (relplt == NULL)
   9426  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   9427  1.1     skrll 
   9428  1.1     skrll   hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
   9429  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
   9430  1.1     skrll       || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
   9431  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   9432  1.1     skrll 
   9433  1.1     skrll   plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
   9434  1.1     skrll   if (plt == NULL)
   9435  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   9436  1.1     skrll 
   9437  1.3  christos   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
   9438  1.3  christos   if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
   9439  1.3  christos     return -1;
   9440  1.3  christos 
   9441  1.3  christos   count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
   9442  1.3  christos   size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
   9443  1.3  christos   p = relplt->relocation;
   9444  1.3  christos   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
   9445  1.3  christos     {
   9446  1.3  christos       size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
   9447  1.3  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   9448  1.1     skrll 	{
   9449  1.3  christos #ifdef BFD64
   9450  1.1     skrll 	  size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
   9451  1.1     skrll #else
   9452  1.1     skrll 	  size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
   9453  1.1     skrll #endif
   9454  1.1     skrll 	}
   9455  1.1     skrll     }
   9456  1.1     skrll 
   9457  1.1     skrll   s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
   9458  1.1     skrll   if (s == NULL)
   9459  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   9460  1.1     skrll 
   9461  1.1     skrll   names = (char *) (s + count);
   9462  1.1     skrll   p = relplt->relocation;
   9463  1.1     skrll   n = 0;
   9464  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
   9465  1.1     skrll     {
   9466  1.1     skrll       size_t len;
   9467  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma addr;
   9468  1.1     skrll 
   9469  1.1     skrll       addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
   9470  1.1     skrll       if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
   9471  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   9472  1.1     skrll 
   9473  1.1     skrll       *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
   9474  1.1     skrll       /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
   9475  1.1     skrll 	 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
   9476  1.1     skrll       if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
   9477  1.1     skrll 	s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
   9478  1.3  christos       s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   9479  1.3  christos       s->section = plt;
   9480  1.3  christos       s->value = addr - plt->vma;
   9481  1.3  christos       s->name = names;
   9482  1.3  christos       s->udata.p = NULL;
   9483  1.3  christos       len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
   9484  1.3  christos       memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
   9485  1.3  christos       names += len;
   9486  1.3  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   9487  1.3  christos 	{
   9488  1.3  christos 	  char buf[30], *a;
   9489  1.3  christos 
   9490  1.3  christos 	  memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
   9491  1.1     skrll 	  names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
   9492  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
   9493  1.1     skrll 	  for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
   9494  1.1     skrll 	    ;
   9495  1.1     skrll 	  len = strlen (a);
   9496  1.1     skrll 	  memcpy (names, a, len);
   9497  1.1     skrll 	  names += len;
   9498  1.1     skrll 	}
   9499  1.1     skrll       memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
   9500  1.1     skrll       names += sizeof ("@plt");
   9501  1.1     skrll       ++s, ++n;
   9502  1.1     skrll     }
   9503  1.1     skrll 
   9504  1.1     skrll   return n;
   9505  1.1     skrll }
   9506  1.1     skrll 
   9507  1.1     skrll /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.  */
   9508  1.1     skrll asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
   9509  1.1     skrll   = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section,
   9510  1.1     skrll 		      SEC_IS_COMMON, NULL, "LARGE_COMMON", 0);
   9511  1.1     skrll 
   9512  1.1     skrll void
   9513  1.3  christos _bfd_elf_set_osabi (bfd * abfd,
   9514  1.3  christos 		    struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   9515  1.3  christos {
   9516  1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp;	/* ELF file header, internal form.  */
   9517  1.3  christos 
   9518  1.3  christos   i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   9519  1.3  christos 
   9520  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
   9521  1.1     skrll 
   9522  1.1     skrll   /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
   9523  1.1     skrll      osabi field to ELFOSABI_LINUX if the binary contains symbols of
   9524  1.1     skrll      the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding.  */
   9525  1.3  christos   if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
   9526  1.1     skrll       && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
   9527  1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_LINUX;
   9528  1.1     skrll }
   9529  1.1     skrll 
   9530  1.3  christos 
   9531  1.3  christos /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
   9532  1.1     skrll    This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
   9533                   most targets.  It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
   9534                
   9535                bfd_boolean
   9536                _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
   9537                {
   9538                  return (type == STT_FUNC
   9539                	  || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
   9540                }
   9541